<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?> | |
<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.1//EN" | |
"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml11/DTD/xhtml11.dtd"> | |
<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en"> | |
<head> | |
<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="application/xhtml+xml; charset=UTF-8" /> | |
<meta name="generator" content="AsciiDoc 9.0.0rc2" /> | |
<title>git-config(1)</title> | |
<style type="text/css"> | |
/* Shared CSS for AsciiDoc xhtml11 and html5 backends */ | |
/* Default font. */ | |
body { | |
font-family: Georgia,serif; | |
} | |
/* Title font. */ | |
h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6, | |
div.title, caption.title, | |
thead, p.table.header, | |
#toctitle, | |
#author, #revnumber, #revdate, #revremark, | |
#footer { | |
font-family: Arial,Helvetica,sans-serif; | |
} | |
body { | |
margin: 1em 5% 1em 5%; | |
} | |
a { | |
color: blue; | |
text-decoration: underline; | |
} | |
a:visited { | |
color: fuchsia; | |
} | |
em { | |
font-style: italic; | |
color: navy; | |
} | |
strong { | |
font-weight: bold; | |
color: #083194; | |
} | |
h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6 { | |
color: #527bbd; | |
margin-top: 1.2em; | |
margin-bottom: 0.5em; | |
line-height: 1.3; | |
} | |
h1, h2, h3 { | |
border-bottom: 2px solid silver; | |
} | |
h2 { | |
padding-top: 0.5em; | |
} | |
h3 { | |
float: left; | |
} | |
h3 + * { | |
clear: left; | |
} | |
h5 { | |
font-size: 1.0em; | |
} | |
div.sectionbody { | |
margin-left: 0; | |
} | |
hr { | |
border: 1px solid silver; | |
} | |
p { | |
margin-top: 0.5em; | |
margin-bottom: 0.5em; | |
} | |
ul, ol, li > p { | |
margin-top: 0; | |
} | |
ul > li { color: #aaa; } | |
ul > li > * { color: black; } | |
.monospaced, code, pre { | |
font-family: "Courier New", Courier, monospace; | |
font-size: inherit; | |
color: navy; | |
padding: 0; | |
margin: 0; | |
} | |
pre { | |
white-space: pre-wrap; | |
} | |
#author { | |
color: #527bbd; | |
font-weight: bold; | |
font-size: 1.1em; | |
} | |
#email { | |
} | |
#revnumber, #revdate, #revremark { | |
} | |
#footer { | |
font-size: small; | |
border-top: 2px solid silver; | |
padding-top: 0.5em; | |
margin-top: 4.0em; | |
} | |
#footer-text { | |
float: left; | |
padding-bottom: 0.5em; | |
} | |
#footer-badges { | |
float: right; | |
padding-bottom: 0.5em; | |
} | |
#preamble { | |
margin-top: 1.5em; | |
margin-bottom: 1.5em; | |
} | |
div.imageblock, div.exampleblock, div.verseblock, | |
div.quoteblock, div.literalblock, div.listingblock, div.sidebarblock, | |
div.admonitionblock { | |
margin-top: 1.0em; | |
margin-bottom: 1.5em; | |
} | |
div.admonitionblock { | |
margin-top: 2.0em; | |
margin-bottom: 2.0em; | |
margin-right: 10%; | |
color: #606060; | |
} | |
div.content { /* Block element content. */ | |
padding: 0; | |
} | |
/* Block element titles. */ | |
div.title, caption.title { | |
color: #527bbd; | |
font-weight: bold; | |
text-align: left; | |
margin-top: 1.0em; | |
margin-bottom: 0.5em; | |
} | |
div.title + * { | |
margin-top: 0; | |
} | |
td div.title:first-child { | |
margin-top: 0.0em; | |
} | |
div.content div.title:first-child { | |
margin-top: 0.0em; | |
} | |
div.content + div.title { | |
margin-top: 0.0em; | |
} | |
div.sidebarblock > div.content { | |
background: #ffffee; | |
border: 1px solid #dddddd; | |
border-left: 4px solid #f0f0f0; | |
padding: 0.5em; | |
} | |
div.listingblock > div.content { | |
border: 1px solid #dddddd; | |
border-left: 5px solid #f0f0f0; | |
background: #f8f8f8; | |
padding: 0.5em; | |
} | |
div.quoteblock, div.verseblock { | |
padding-left: 1.0em; | |
margin-left: 1.0em; | |
margin-right: 10%; | |
border-left: 5px solid #f0f0f0; | |
color: #888; | |
} | |
div.quoteblock > div.attribution { | |
padding-top: 0.5em; | |
text-align: right; | |
} | |
div.verseblock > pre.content { | |
font-family: inherit; | |
font-size: inherit; | |
} | |
div.verseblock > div.attribution { | |
padding-top: 0.75em; | |
text-align: left; | |
} | |
/* DEPRECATED: Pre version 8.2.7 verse style literal block. */ | |
div.verseblock + div.attribution { | |
text-align: left; | |
} | |
div.admonitionblock .icon { | |
vertical-align: top; | |
font-size: 1.1em; | |
font-weight: bold; | |
text-decoration: underline; | |
color: #527bbd; | |
padding-right: 0.5em; | |
} | |
div.admonitionblock td.content { | |
padding-left: 0.5em; | |
border-left: 3px solid #dddddd; | |
} | |
div.exampleblock > div.content { | |
border-left: 3px solid #dddddd; | |
padding-left: 0.5em; | |
} | |
div.imageblock div.content { padding-left: 0; } | |
span.image img { border-style: none; vertical-align: text-bottom; } | |
a.image:visited { color: white; } | |
dl { | |
margin-top: 0.8em; | |
margin-bottom: 0.8em; | |
} | |
dt { | |
margin-top: 0.5em; | |
margin-bottom: 0; | |
font-style: normal; | |
color: navy; | |
} | |
dd > *:first-child { | |
margin-top: 0.1em; | |
} | |
ul, ol { | |
list-style-position: outside; | |
} | |
ol.arabic { | |
list-style-type: decimal; | |
} | |
ol.loweralpha { | |
list-style-type: lower-alpha; | |
} | |
ol.upperalpha { | |
list-style-type: upper-alpha; | |
} | |
ol.lowerroman { | |
list-style-type: lower-roman; | |
} | |
ol.upperroman { | |
list-style-type: upper-roman; | |
} | |
div.compact ul, div.compact ol, | |
div.compact p, div.compact p, | |
div.compact div, div.compact div { | |
margin-top: 0.1em; | |
margin-bottom: 0.1em; | |
} | |
tfoot { | |
font-weight: bold; | |
} | |
td > div.verse { | |
white-space: pre; | |
} | |
div.hdlist { | |
margin-top: 0.8em; | |
margin-bottom: 0.8em; | |
} | |
div.hdlist tr { | |
padding-bottom: 15px; | |
} | |
dt.hdlist1.strong, td.hdlist1.strong { | |
font-weight: bold; | |
} | |
td.hdlist1 { | |
vertical-align: top; | |
font-style: normal; | |
padding-right: 0.8em; | |
color: navy; | |
} | |
td.hdlist2 { | |
vertical-align: top; | |
} | |
div.hdlist.compact tr { | |
margin: 0; | |
padding-bottom: 0; | |
} | |
.comment { | |
background: yellow; | |
} | |
.footnote, .footnoteref { | |
font-size: 0.8em; | |
} | |
span.footnote, span.footnoteref { | |
vertical-align: super; | |
} | |
#footnotes { | |
margin: 20px 0 20px 0; | |
padding: 7px 0 0 0; | |
} | |
#footnotes div.footnote { | |
margin: 0 0 5px 0; | |
} | |
#footnotes hr { | |
border: none; | |
border-top: 1px solid silver; | |
height: 1px; | |
text-align: left; | |
margin-left: 0; | |
width: 20%; | |
min-width: 100px; | |
} | |
div.colist td { | |
padding-right: 0.5em; | |
padding-bottom: 0.3em; | |
vertical-align: top; | |
} | |
div.colist td img { | |
margin-top: 0.3em; | |
} | |
@media print { | |
#footer-badges { display: none; } | |
} | |
#toc { | |
margin-bottom: 2.5em; | |
} | |
#toctitle { | |
color: #527bbd; | |
font-size: 1.1em; | |
font-weight: bold; | |
margin-top: 1.0em; | |
margin-bottom: 0.1em; | |
} | |
div.toclevel0, div.toclevel1, div.toclevel2, div.toclevel3, div.toclevel4 { | |
margin-top: 0; | |
margin-bottom: 0; | |
} | |
div.toclevel2 { | |
margin-left: 2em; | |
font-size: 0.9em; | |
} | |
div.toclevel3 { | |
margin-left: 4em; | |
font-size: 0.9em; | |
} | |
div.toclevel4 { | |
margin-left: 6em; | |
font-size: 0.9em; | |
} | |
span.aqua { color: aqua; } | |
span.black { color: black; } | |
span.blue { color: blue; } | |
span.fuchsia { color: fuchsia; } | |
span.gray { color: gray; } | |
span.green { color: green; } | |
span.lime { color: lime; } | |
span.maroon { color: maroon; } | |
span.navy { color: navy; } | |
span.olive { color: olive; } | |
span.purple { color: purple; } | |
span.red { color: red; } | |
span.silver { color: silver; } | |
span.teal { color: teal; } | |
span.white { color: white; } | |
span.yellow { color: yellow; } | |
span.aqua-background { background: aqua; } | |
span.black-background { background: black; } | |
span.blue-background { background: blue; } | |
span.fuchsia-background { background: fuchsia; } | |
span.gray-background { background: gray; } | |
span.green-background { background: green; } | |
span.lime-background { background: lime; } | |
span.maroon-background { background: maroon; } | |
span.navy-background { background: navy; } | |
span.olive-background { background: olive; } | |
span.purple-background { background: purple; } | |
span.red-background { background: red; } | |
span.silver-background { background: silver; } | |
span.teal-background { background: teal; } | |
span.white-background { background: white; } | |
span.yellow-background { background: yellow; } | |
span.big { font-size: 2em; } | |
span.small { font-size: 0.6em; } | |
span.underline { text-decoration: underline; } | |
span.overline { text-decoration: overline; } | |
span.line-through { text-decoration: line-through; } | |
div.unbreakable { page-break-inside: avoid; } | |
/* | |
* xhtml11 specific | |
* | |
* */ | |
div.tableblock { | |
margin-top: 1.0em; | |
margin-bottom: 1.5em; | |
} | |
div.tableblock > table { | |
border: 3px solid #527bbd; | |
} | |
thead, p.table.header { | |
font-weight: bold; | |
color: #527bbd; | |
} | |
p.table { | |
margin-top: 0; | |
} | |
/* Because the table frame attribute is overridden by CSS in most browsers. */ | |
div.tableblock > table[frame="void"] { | |
border-style: none; | |
} | |
div.tableblock > table[frame="hsides"] { | |
border-left-style: none; | |
border-right-style: none; | |
} | |
div.tableblock > table[frame="vsides"] { | |
border-top-style: none; | |
border-bottom-style: none; | |
} | |
/* | |
* html5 specific | |
* | |
* */ | |
table.tableblock { | |
margin-top: 1.0em; | |
margin-bottom: 1.5em; | |
} | |
thead, p.tableblock.header { | |
font-weight: bold; | |
color: #527bbd; | |
} | |
p.tableblock { | |
margin-top: 0; | |
} | |
table.tableblock { | |
border-width: 3px; | |
border-spacing: 0px; | |
border-style: solid; | |
border-color: #527bbd; | |
border-collapse: collapse; | |
} | |
th.tableblock, td.tableblock { | |
border-width: 1px; | |
padding: 4px; | |
border-style: solid; | |
border-color: #527bbd; | |
} | |
table.tableblock.frame-topbot { | |
border-left-style: hidden; | |
border-right-style: hidden; | |
} | |
table.tableblock.frame-sides { | |
border-top-style: hidden; | |
border-bottom-style: hidden; | |
} | |
table.tableblock.frame-none { | |
border-style: hidden; | |
} | |
th.tableblock.halign-left, td.tableblock.halign-left { | |
text-align: left; | |
} | |
th.tableblock.halign-center, td.tableblock.halign-center { | |
text-align: center; | |
} | |
th.tableblock.halign-right, td.tableblock.halign-right { | |
text-align: right; | |
} | |
th.tableblock.valign-top, td.tableblock.valign-top { | |
vertical-align: top; | |
} | |
th.tableblock.valign-middle, td.tableblock.valign-middle { | |
vertical-align: middle; | |
} | |
th.tableblock.valign-bottom, td.tableblock.valign-bottom { | |
vertical-align: bottom; | |
} | |
/* | |
* manpage specific | |
* | |
* */ | |
body.manpage h1 { | |
padding-top: 0.5em; | |
padding-bottom: 0.5em; | |
border-top: 2px solid silver; | |
border-bottom: 2px solid silver; | |
} | |
body.manpage h2 { | |
border-style: none; | |
} | |
body.manpage div.sectionbody { | |
margin-left: 3em; | |
} | |
@media print { | |
body.manpage div#toc { display: none; } | |
} | |
</style> | |
<script type="text/javascript"> | |
/*<+'])'); | |
// Function that scans the DOM tree for header elements (the DOM2 | |
// nodeIterator API would be a better technique but not supported by all | |
// browsers). | |
var iterate = function (el) { | |
for (var i = el.firstChild; i != null; i = i.nextSibling) { | |
if (i.nodeType == 1 /* Node.ELEMENT_NODE */) { | |
var mo = re.exec(i.tagName); | |
if (mo && (i.getAttribute("class") || i.getAttribute("className")) != "float") { | |
result[result.length] = new TocEntry(i, getText(i), mo[1]-1); | |
} | |
iterate(i); | |
} | |
} | |
} | |
iterate(el); | |
return result; | |
} | |
var toc = document.getElementById("toc"); | |
if (!toc) { | |
return; | |
} | |
// Delete existing TOC entries in case we're reloading the TOC. | |
var tocEntriesToRemove = []; | |
var i; | |
for (i = 0; i < toc.childNodes.length; i++) { | |
var entry = toc.childNodes[i]; | |
if (entry.nodeName.toLowerCase() == 'div' | |
&& entry.getAttribute("class") | |
&& entry.getAttribute("class").match(/^toclevel/)) | |
tocEntriesToRemove.push(entry); | |
} | |
for (i = 0; i < tocEntriesToRemove.length; i++) { | |
toc.removeChild(tocEntriesToRemove[i]); | |
} | |
// Rebuild TOC entries. | |
var entries = tocEntries(document.getElementById("content"), toclevels); | |
for (var i = 0; i < entries.length; ++i) { | |
var entry = entries[i]; | |
if (entry.element.id == "") | |
entry.element.id = "_toc_" + i; | |
var a = document.createElement("a"); | |
a.href = "#" + entry.element.id; | |
a.appendChild(document.createTextNode(entry.text)); | |
var div = document.createElement("div"); | |
div.appendChild(a); | |
div.className = "toclevel" + entry.toclevel; | |
toc.appendChild(div); | |
} | |
if (entries.length == 0) | |
toc.parentNode.removeChild(toc); | |
}, | |
///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// | |
// Footnotes generator | |
///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// | |
/* Based on footnote generation code from: | |
* http://www.brandspankingnew.net/archive/2005/07/format_footnote.html | |
*/ | |
footnotes: function () { | |
// Delete existing footnote entries in case we're reloading the footnodes. | |
var i; | |
var noteholder = document.getElementById("footnotes"); | |
if (!noteholder) { | |
return; | |
} | |
var entriesToRemove = []; | |
for (i = 0; i < noteholder.childNodes.length; i++) { | |
var entry = noteholder.childNodes[i]; | |
if (entry.nodeName.toLowerCase() == 'div' && entry.getAttribute("class") == "footnote") | |
entriesToRemove.push(entry); | |
} | |
for (i = 0; i < entriesToRemove.length; i++) { | |
noteholder.removeChild(entriesToRemove[i]); | |
} | |
// Rebuild footnote entries. | |
var cont = document.getElementById("content"); | |
var spans = cont.getElementsByTagName("span"); | |
var refs = {}; | |
var n = 0; | |
for (i=0; i<spans.length; i++) { | |
if (spans[i].className == "footnote") { | |
n++; | |
var note = spans[i].getAttribute("data-note"); | |
if (!note) { | |
// Use [\s\S] in place of . so multi-line matches work. | |
// Because JavaScript has no s (dotall) regex flag. | |
note = spans[i].innerHTML.match(/\s*\[([\s\S]*)]\s*/)[1]; | |
spans[i].innerHTML = | |
"[<a id='_footnoteref_" + n + "' href='#_footnote_" + n + | |
"' title='View footnote' class='footnote'>" + n + "</a>]"; | |
spans[i].setAttribute("data-note", note); | |
} | |
noteholder.innerHTML += | |
"<div class='footnote' id='_footnote_" + n + "'>" + | |
"<a href='#_footnoteref_" + n + "' title='Return to text'>" + | |
n + "</a>. " + note + "</div>"; | |
var id =spans[i].getAttribute("id"); | |
if (id != null) refs["#"+id] = n; | |
} | |
} | |
if (n == 0) | |
noteholder.parentNode.removeChild(noteholder); | |
else { | |
// Process footnoterefs. | |
for (i=0; i<spans.length; i++) { | |
if (spans[i].className == "footnoteref") { | |
var href = spans[i].getElementsByTagName("a")[0].getAttribute("href"); | |
href = href.match(/#.*/)[0]; // Because IE return full URL. | |
n = refs[href]; | |
spans[i].innerHTML = | |
"[<a href='#_footnote_" + n + | |
"' title='View footnote' class='footnote'>" + n + "</a>]"; | |
} | |
} | |
} | |
}, | |
install: function(toclevels) { | |
var timerId; | |
function reinstall() { | |
asciidoc.footnotes(); | |
if (toclevels) { | |
asciidoc.toc(toclevels); | |
} | |
} | |
function reinstallAndRemoveTimer() { | |
clearInterval(timerId); | |
reinstall(); | |
} | |
timerId = setInterval(reinstall, 500); | |
if (document.addEventListener) | |
document.addEventListener("DOMContentLoaded", reinstallAndRemoveTimer, false); | |
else | |
window.onload = reinstallAndRemoveTimer; | |
} | |
} | |
asciidoc.install(); | |
/*]]>*/ | |
</script> | |
</head> | |
<body class="manpage"> | |
<div id="header"> | |
<h1> | |
git-config(1) Manual Page | |
</h1> | |
<h2>NAME</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<p>git-config - | |
Get and set repository or global options | |
</p> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div id="content"> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="_synopsis">SYNOPSIS</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="verseblock"> | |
<pre class="content"><em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--type=<type>] [--fixed-value] [--show-origin] [--show-scope] [-z|--null] name [value [value-pattern]] | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--type=<type>] --add name value | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--type=<type>] [--fixed-value] --replace-all name value [value-pattern] | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--type=<type>] [--show-origin] [--show-scope] [-z|--null] [--fixed-value] --get name [value-pattern] | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--type=<type>] [--show-origin] [--show-scope] [-z|--null] [--fixed-value] --get-all name [value-pattern] | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--type=<type>] [--show-origin] [--show-scope] [-z|--null] [--fixed-value] [--name-only] --get-regexp name_regex [value-pattern] | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--type=<type>] [-z|--null] --get-urlmatch name URL | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--fixed-value] --unset name [value-pattern] | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--fixed-value] --unset-all name [value-pattern] | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] --rename-section old_name new_name | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] --remove-section name | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] [--show-origin] [--show-scope] [-z|--null] [--name-only] -l | --list | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] --get-color name [default] | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] --get-colorbool name [stdout-is-tty] | |
<em>git config</em> [<file-option>] -e | --edit</pre> | |
<div class="attribution"> | |
</div></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="_description">DESCRIPTION</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>You can query/set/replace/unset options with this command. The name is | |
actually the section and the key separated by a dot, and the value will be | |
escaped.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Multiple lines can be added to an option by using the <code>--add</code> option. | |
If you want to update or unset an option which can occur on multiple | |
lines, a <code>value-pattern</code> (which is an extended regular expression, | |
unless the <code>--fixed-value</code> option is given) needs to be given. Only the | |
existing values that match the pattern are updated or unset. If | |
you want to handle the lines that do <strong>not</strong> match the pattern, just | |
prepend a single exclamation mark in front (see also <a href="#EXAMPLES">[EXAMPLES]</a>), | |
but note that this only works when the <code>--fixed-value</code> option is not | |
in use.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <code>--type=<type></code> option instructs <em>git config</em> to ensure that incoming and | |
outgoing values are canonicalize-able under the given <type>. If no | |
<code>--type=<type></code> is given, no canonicalization will be performed. Callers may | |
unset an existing <code>--type</code> specifier with <code>--no-type</code>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When reading, the values are read from the system, global and | |
repository local configuration files by default, and options | |
<code>--system</code>, <code>--global</code>, <code>--local</code>, <code>--worktree</code> and | |
<code>--file <filename></code> can be used to tell the command to read from only | |
that location (see <a href="#FILES">[FILES]</a>).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When writing, the new value is written to the repository local | |
configuration file by default, and options <code>--system</code>, <code>--global</code>, | |
<code>--worktree</code>, <code>--file <filename></code> can be used to tell the command to | |
write to that location (you can say <code>--local</code> but that is the | |
default).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command will fail with non-zero status upon error. Some exit | |
codes are:</p></div> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
The section or key is invalid (ret=1), | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
no section or name was provided (ret=2), | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
the config file is invalid (ret=3), | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
the config file cannot be written (ret=4), | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
you try to unset an option which does not exist (ret=5), | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
you try to unset/set an option for which multiple lines match (ret=5), or | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
you try to use an invalid regexp (ret=6). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>On success, the command returns the exit code 0.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>A list of all available configuration variables can be obtained using the | |
<code>git help --config</code> command.</p></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="OPTIONS">OPTIONS</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--replace-all | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Default behavior is to replace at most one line. This replaces | |
all lines matching the key (and optionally the <code>value-pattern</code>). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--add | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Adds a new line to the option without altering any existing | |
values. This is the same as providing <em>^$</em> as the <code>value-pattern</code> | |
in <code>--replace-all</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--get | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Get the value for a given key (optionally filtered by a regex | |
matching the value). Returns error code 1 if the key was not | |
found and the last value if multiple key values were found. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--get-all | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Like get, but returns all values for a multi-valued key. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--get-regexp | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Like --get-all, but interprets the name as a regular expression and | |
writes out the key names. Regular expression matching is currently | |
case-sensitive and done against a canonicalized version of the key | |
in which section and variable names are lowercased, but subsection | |
names are not. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--get-urlmatch name URL | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When given a two-part name section.key, the value for | |
section.<url>.key whose <url> part matches the best to the | |
given URL is returned (if no such key exists, the value for | |
section.key is used as a fallback). When given just the | |
section as name, do so for all the keys in the section and | |
list them. Returns error code 1 if no value is found. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--global | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
For writing options: write to global <code>~/.gitconfig</code> file | |
rather than the repository <code>.git/config</code>, write to | |
<code>$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/git/config</code> file if this file exists and the | |
<code>~/.gitconfig</code> file doesn’t. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For reading options: read only from global <code>~/.gitconfig</code> and from | |
<code>$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/git/config</code> rather than from all available files.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#FILES">[FILES]</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--system | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
For writing options: write to system-wide | |
<code>$(prefix)/etc/gitconfig</code> rather than the repository | |
<code>.git/config</code>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For reading options: read only from system-wide <code>$(prefix)/etc/gitconfig</code> | |
rather than from all available files.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#FILES">[FILES]</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--local | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
For writing options: write to the repository <code>.git/config</code> file. | |
This is the default behavior. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For reading options: read only from the repository <code>.git/config</code> rather than | |
from all available files.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#FILES">[FILES]</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--worktree | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Similar to <code>--local</code> except that <code>.git/config.worktree</code> is | |
read from or written to if <code>extensions.worktreeConfig</code> is | |
present. If not it’s the same as <code>--local</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
-f config-file | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--file config-file | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
For writing options: write to the specified file rather than the | |
repository <code>.git/config</code>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For reading options: read only from the specified file rather than from all | |
available files.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#FILES">[FILES]</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--blob blob | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Similar to <code>--file</code> but use the given blob instead of a file. E.g. | |
you can use <em>master:.gitmodules</em> to read values from the file | |
<em>.gitmodules</em> in the master branch. See "SPECIFYING REVISIONS" | |
section in <a href="gitrevisions.html">gitrevisions(7)</a> for a more complete list of | |
ways to spell blob names. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--remove-section | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Remove the given section from the configuration file. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--rename-section | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Rename the given section to a new name. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--unset | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Remove the line matching the key from config file. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--unset-all | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Remove all lines matching the key from config file. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
-l | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--list | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
List all variables set in config file, along with their values. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--fixed-value | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When used with the <code>value-pattern</code> argument, treat <code>value-pattern</code> as | |
an exact string instead of a regular expression. This will restrict | |
the name/value pairs that are matched to only those where the value | |
is exactly equal to the <code>value-pattern</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--type <type> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
<em>git config</em> will ensure that any input or output is valid under the given | |
type constraint(s), and will canonicalize outgoing values in <code><type></code>'s | |
canonical form. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Valid <code><type></code>'s include:</p></div> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<em>bool</em>: canonicalize values as either "true" or "false". | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<em>int</em>: canonicalize values as simple decimal numbers. An optional suffix of | |
<em>k</em>, <em>m</em>, or <em>g</em> will cause the value to be multiplied by 1024, 1048576, or | |
1073741824 upon input. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<em>bool-or-int</em>: canonicalize according to either <em>bool</em> or <em>int</em>, as described | |
above. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<em>path</em>: canonicalize by adding a leading <code>~</code> to the value of <code>$HOME</code> and | |
<code>~user</code> to the home directory for the specified user. This specifier has no | |
effect when setting the value (but you can use <code>git config section.variable | |
~/</code> from the command line to let your shell do the expansion.) | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<em>expiry-date</em>: canonicalize by converting from a fixed or relative date-string | |
to a timestamp. This specifier has no effect when setting the value. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<em>color</em>: When getting a value, canonicalize by converting to an ANSI color | |
escape sequence. When setting a value, a sanity-check is performed to ensure | |
that the given value is canonicalize-able as an ANSI color, but it is written | |
as-is. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--bool | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--int | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--bool-or-int | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--path | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--expiry-date | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Historical options for selecting a type specifier. Prefer instead <code>--type</code> | |
(see above). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--no-type | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Un-sets the previously set type specifier (if one was previously set). This | |
option requests that <em>git config</em> not canonicalize the retrieved variable. | |
<code>--no-type</code> has no effect without <code>--type=<type></code> or <code>--<type></code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
-z | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--null | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
For all options that output values and/or keys, always | |
end values with the null character (instead of a | |
newline). Use newline instead as a delimiter between | |
key and value. This allows for secure parsing of the | |
output without getting confused e.g. by values that | |
contain line breaks. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--name-only | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Output only the names of config variables for <code>--list</code> or | |
<code>--get-regexp</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--show-origin | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Augment the output of all queried config options with the | |
origin type (file, standard input, blob, command line) and | |
the actual origin (config file path, ref, or blob id if | |
applicable). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--show-scope | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Similar to <code>--show-origin</code> in that it augments the output of | |
all queried config options with the scope of that value | |
(local, global, system, command). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--get-colorbool name [stdout-is-tty] | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Find the color setting for <code>name</code> (e.g. <code>color.diff</code>) and output | |
"true" or "false". <code>stdout-is-tty</code> should be either "true" or | |
"false", and is taken into account when configuration says | |
"auto". If <code>stdout-is-tty</code> is missing, then checks the standard | |
output of the command itself, and exits with status 0 if color | |
is to be used, or exits with status 1 otherwise. | |
When the color setting for <code>name</code> is undefined, the command uses | |
<code>color.ui</code> as fallback. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--get-color name [default] | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Find the color configured for <code>name</code> (e.g. <code>color.diff.new</code>) and | |
output it as the ANSI color escape sequence to the standard | |
output. The optional <code>default</code> parameter is used instead, if | |
there is no color configured for <code>name</code>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p><code>--type=color [--default=<default>]</code> is preferred over <code>--get-color</code> | |
(but note that <code>--get-color</code> will omit the trailing newline printed by | |
<code>--type=color</code>).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
-e | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--edit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Opens an editor to modify the specified config file; either | |
<code>--system</code>, <code>--global</code>, or repository (default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--[no-]includes | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Respect <code>include.*</code> directives in config files when looking up | |
values. Defaults to <code>off</code> when a specific file is given (e.g., | |
using <code>--file</code>, <code>--global</code>, etc) and <code>on</code> when searching all | |
config files. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
--default <value> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When using <code>--get</code>, and the requested variable is not found, behave as if | |
<value> were the value assigned to the that variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="_configuration">CONFIGURATION</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p><code>pager.config</code> is only respected when listing configuration, i.e., when | |
using <code>--list</code> or any of the <code>--get-*</code> which may return multiple results. | |
The default is to use a pager.</p></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="FILES">FILES</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If not set explicitly with <code>--file</code>, there are four files where | |
<em>git config</em> will search for configuration options:</p></div> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
$(prefix)/etc/gitconfig | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
System-wide configuration file. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/git/config | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Second user-specific configuration file. If $XDG_CONFIG_HOME is not set | |
or empty, <code>$HOME/.config/git/config</code> will be used. Any single-valued | |
variable set in this file will be overwritten by whatever is in | |
<code>~/.gitconfig</code>. It is a good idea not to create this file if | |
you sometimes use older versions of Git, as support for this | |
file was added fairly recently. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
~/.gitconfig | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
User-specific configuration file. Also called "global" | |
configuration file. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
$GIT_DIR/config | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Repository specific configuration file. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
$GIT_DIR/config.worktree | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This is optional and is only searched when | |
<code>extensions.worktreeConfig</code> is present in $GIT_DIR/config. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If no further options are given, all reading options will read all of these | |
files that are available. If the global or the system-wide configuration | |
file are not available they will be ignored. If the repository configuration | |
file is not available or readable, <em>git config</em> will exit with a non-zero | |
error code. However, in neither case will an error message be issued.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The files are read in the order given above, with last value found taking | |
precedence over values read earlier. When multiple values are taken then all | |
values of a key from all files will be used.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>You may override individual configuration parameters when running any git | |
command by using the <code>-c</code> option. See <a href="git.html">git(1)</a> for details.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>All writing options will per default write to the repository specific | |
configuration file. Note that this also affects options like <code>--replace-all</code> | |
and <code>--unset</code>. <strong><em>git config</em> will only ever change one file at a time</strong>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>You can override these rules using the <code>--global</code>, <code>--system</code>, | |
<code>--local</code>, <code>--worktree</code>, and <code>--file</code> command-line options; see | |
<a href="#OPTIONS">[OPTIONS]</a> above.</p></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="_environment">ENVIRONMENT</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
GIT_CONFIG_GLOBAL | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
GIT_CONFIG_SYSTEM | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Take the configuration from the given files instead from global or | |
system-level configuration. See <a href="git.html">git(1)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
GIT_CONFIG_NOSYSTEM | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether to skip reading settings from the system-wide | |
$(prefix)/etc/gitconfig file. See <a href="git.html">git(1)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#FILES">[FILES]</a>.</p></div> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
GIT_CONFIG_COUNT | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
GIT_CONFIG_KEY_<n> | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
GIT_CONFIG_VALUE_<n> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If GIT_CONFIG_COUNT is set to a positive number, all environment pairs | |
GIT_CONFIG_KEY_<n> and GIT_CONFIG_VALUE_<n> up to that number will be | |
added to the process’s runtime configuration. The config pairs are | |
zero-indexed. Any missing key or value is treated as an error. An empty | |
GIT_CONFIG_COUNT is treated the same as GIT_CONFIG_COUNT=0, namely no | |
pairs are processed. These environment variables will override values | |
in configuration files, but will be overridden by any explicit options | |
passed via <code>git -c</code>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This is useful for cases where you want to spawn multiple git commands | |
with a common configuration but cannot depend on a configuration file, | |
for example when writing scripts.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
GIT_CONFIG | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If no <code>--file</code> option is provided to <code>git config</code>, use the file | |
given by <code>GIT_CONFIG</code> as if it were provided via <code>--file</code>. This | |
variable has no effect on other Git commands, and is mostly for | |
historical compatibility; there is generally no reason to use it | |
instead of the <code>--file</code> option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="EXAMPLES">EXAMPLES</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Given a .git/config like this:</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code># | |
# This is the config file, and | |
# a '#' or ';' character indicates | |
# a comment | |
# | |
; core variables | |
[core] | |
; Don't trust file modes | |
filemode = false | |
; Our diff algorithm | |
[diff] | |
external = /usr/local/bin/diff-wrapper | |
renames = true | |
; Proxy settings | |
[core] | |
gitproxy=proxy-command for kernel.org | |
gitproxy=default-proxy ; for all the rest | |
; HTTP | |
[http] | |
sslVerify | |
[http "https://weak.example.com"] | |
sslVerify = false | |
cookieFile = /tmp/cookie.txt</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>you can set the filemode to true with</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config core.filemode true</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The hypothetical proxy command entries actually have a postfix to discern | |
what URL they apply to. Here is how to change the entry for kernel.org | |
to "ssh".</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config core.gitproxy '"ssh" for kernel.org' 'for kernel.org$'</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This makes sure that only the key/value pair for kernel.org is replaced.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>To delete the entry for renames, do</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config --unset diff.renames</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If you want to delete an entry for a multivar (like core.gitproxy above), | |
you have to provide a regex matching the value of exactly one line.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>To query the value for a given key, do</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config --get core.filemode</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>or</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config core.filemode</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>or, to query a multivar:</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config --get core.gitproxy "for kernel.org$"</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If you want to know all the values for a multivar, do:</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config --get-all core.gitproxy</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If you like to live dangerously, you can replace <strong>all</strong> core.gitproxy by a | |
new one with</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config --replace-all core.gitproxy ssh</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>However, if you really only want to replace the line for the default proxy, | |
i.e. the one without a "for …" postfix, do something like this:</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config core.gitproxy ssh '! for '</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>To actually match only values with an exclamation mark, you have to</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config section.key value '[!]'</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>To add a new proxy, without altering any of the existing ones, use</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config --add core.gitproxy '"proxy-command" for example.com'</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>An example to use customized color from the configuration in your | |
script:</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>#!/bin/sh | |
WS=$(git config --get-color color.diff.whitespace "blue reverse") | |
RESET=$(git config --get-color "" "reset") | |
echo "${WS}your whitespace color or blue reverse${RESET}"</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For URLs in <code>https://weak.example.com</code>, <code>http.sslVerify</code> is set to | |
false, while it is set to <code>true</code> for all others:</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>% git config --type=bool --get-urlmatch http.sslverify https://good.example.com | |
true | |
% git config --type=bool --get-urlmatch http.sslverify https://weak.example.com | |
false | |
% git config --get-urlmatch http https://weak.example.com | |
http.cookieFile /tmp/cookie.txt | |
http.sslverify false</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="_configuration_file">CONFIGURATION FILE</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The Git configuration file contains a number of variables that affect | |
the Git commands' behavior. The files <code>.git/config</code> and optionally | |
<code>config.worktree</code> (see the "CONFIGURATION FILE" section of | |
<a href="git-worktree.html">git-worktree(1)</a>) in each repository are used to store the | |
configuration for that repository, and <code>$HOME/.gitconfig</code> is used to | |
store a per-user configuration as fallback values for the <code>.git/config</code> | |
file. The file <code>/etc/gitconfig</code> can be used to store a system-wide | |
default configuration.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The configuration variables are used by both the Git plumbing | |
and the porcelains. The variables are divided into sections, wherein | |
the fully qualified variable name of the variable itself is the last | |
dot-separated segment and the section name is everything before the last | |
dot. The variable names are case-insensitive, allow only alphanumeric | |
characters and <code>-</code>, and must start with an alphabetic character. Some | |
variables may appear multiple times; we say then that the variable is | |
multivalued.</p></div> | |
<div class="sect2"> | |
<h3 id="_syntax">Syntax</h3> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The syntax is fairly flexible and permissive; whitespaces are mostly | |
ignored. The <em>#</em> and <em>;</em> characters begin comments to the end of line, | |
blank lines are ignored.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The file consists of sections and variables. A section begins with | |
the name of the section in square brackets and continues until the next | |
section begins. Section names are case-insensitive. Only alphanumeric | |
characters, <code>-</code> and <code>.</code> are allowed in section names. Each variable | |
must belong to some section, which means that there must be a section | |
header before the first setting of a variable.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Sections can be further divided into subsections. To begin a subsection | |
put its name in double quotes, separated by space from the section name, | |
in the section header, like in the example below:</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code> [section "subsection"]</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Subsection names are case sensitive and can contain any characters except | |
newline and the null byte. Doublequote <code>"</code> and backslash can be included | |
by escaping them as <code>\"</code> and <code>\\</code>, respectively. Backslashes preceding | |
other characters are dropped when reading; for example, <code>\t</code> is read as | |
<code>t</code> and <code>\0</code> is read as <code>0</code>. Section headers cannot span multiple lines. | |
Variables may belong directly to a section or to a given subsection. You | |
can have <code>[section]</code> if you have <code>[section "subsection"]</code>, but you don’t | |
need to.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>There is also a deprecated <code>[section.subsection]</code> syntax. With this | |
syntax, the subsection name is converted to lower-case and is also | |
compared case sensitively. These subsection names follow the same | |
restrictions as section names.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>All the other lines (and the remainder of the line after the section | |
header) are recognized as setting variables, in the form | |
<em>name = value</em> (or just <em>name</em>, which is a short-hand to say that | |
the variable is the boolean "true"). | |
The variable names are case-insensitive, allow only alphanumeric characters | |
and <code>-</code>, and must start with an alphabetic character.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>A line that defines a value can be continued to the next line by | |
ending it with a <code>\</code>; the backslash and the end-of-line are | |
stripped. Leading whitespaces after <em>name =</em>, the remainder of the | |
line after the first comment character <em>#</em> or <em>;</em>, and trailing | |
whitespaces of the line are discarded unless they are enclosed in | |
double quotes. Internal whitespaces within the value are retained | |
verbatim.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Inside double quotes, double quote <code>"</code> and backslash <code>\</code> characters | |
must be escaped: use <code>\"</code> for <code>"</code> and <code>\\</code> for <code>\</code>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The following escape sequences (beside <code>\"</code> and <code>\\</code>) are recognized: | |
<code>\n</code> for newline character (NL), <code>\t</code> for horizontal tabulation (HT, TAB) | |
and <code>\b</code> for backspace (BS). Other char escape sequences (including octal | |
escape sequences) are invalid.</p></div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect2"> | |
<h3 id="_includes">Includes</h3> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <code>include</code> and <code>includeIf</code> sections allow you to include config | |
directives from another source. These sections behave identically to | |
each other with the exception that <code>includeIf</code> sections may be ignored | |
if their condition does not evaluate to true; see "Conditional includes" | |
below.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>You can include a config file from another by setting the special | |
<code>include.path</code> (or <code>includeIf.*.path</code>) variable to the name of the file | |
to be included. The variable takes a pathname as its value, and is | |
subject to tilde expansion. These variables can be given multiple times.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The contents of the included file are inserted immediately, as if they | |
had been found at the location of the include directive. If the value of the | |
variable is a relative path, the path is considered to | |
be relative to the configuration file in which the include directive | |
was found. See below for examples.</p></div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect2"> | |
<h3 id="_conditional_includes">Conditional includes</h3> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>You can include a config file from another conditionally by setting a | |
<code>includeIf.<condition>.path</code> variable to the name of the file to be | |
included.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The condition starts with a keyword followed by a colon and some data | |
whose format and meaning depends on the keyword. Supported keywords | |
are:</p></div> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>gitdir</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The data that follows the keyword <code>gitdir:</code> is used as a glob | |
pattern. If the location of the .git directory matches the | |
pattern, the include condition is met. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The .git location may be auto-discovered, or come from <code>$GIT_DIR</code> | |
environment variable. If the repository is auto discovered via a .git | |
file (e.g. from submodules, or a linked worktree), the .git location | |
would be the final location where the .git directory is, not where the | |
.git file is.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The pattern can contain standard globbing wildcards and two additional | |
ones, <code>**/</code> and <code>/**</code>, that can match multiple path components. Please | |
refer to <a href="gitignore.html">gitignore(5)</a> for details. For convenience:</p></div> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
If the pattern starts with <code>~/</code>, <code>~</code> will be substituted with the | |
content of the environment variable <code>HOME</code>. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
If the pattern starts with <code>./</code>, it is replaced with the directory | |
containing the current config file. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
If the pattern does not start with either <code>~/</code>, <code>./</code> or <code>/</code>, <code>**/</code> | |
will be automatically prepended. For example, the pattern <code>foo/bar</code> | |
becomes <code>**/foo/bar</code> and would match <code>/any/path/to/foo/bar</code>. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
If the pattern ends with <code>/</code>, <code>**</code> will be automatically added. For | |
example, the pattern <code>foo/</code> becomes <code>foo/**</code>. In other words, it | |
matches "foo" and everything inside, recursively. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>gitdir/i</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This is the same as <code>gitdir</code> except that matching is done | |
case-insensitively (e.g. on case-insensitive file systems) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>onbranch</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The data that follows the keyword <code>onbranch:</code> is taken to be a | |
pattern with standard globbing wildcards and two additional | |
ones, <code>**/</code> and <code>/**</code>, that can match multiple path components. | |
If we are in a worktree where the name of the branch that is | |
currently checked out matches the pattern, the include condition | |
is met. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the pattern ends with <code>/</code>, <code>**</code> will be automatically added. For | |
example, the pattern <code>foo/</code> becomes <code>foo/**</code>. In other words, it matches | |
all branches that begin with <code>foo/</code>. This is useful if your branches are | |
organized hierarchically and you would like to apply a configuration to | |
all the branches in that hierarchy.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>A few more notes on matching via <code>gitdir</code> and <code>gitdir/i</code>:</p></div> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
Symlinks in <code>$GIT_DIR</code> are not resolved before matching. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
Both the symlink & realpath versions of paths will be matched | |
outside of <code>$GIT_DIR</code>. E.g. if ~/git is a symlink to | |
/mnt/storage/git, both <code>gitdir:~/git</code> and <code>gitdir:/mnt/storage/git</code> | |
will match. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This was not the case in the initial release of this feature in | |
v2.13.0, which only matched the realpath version. Configuration that | |
wants to be compatible with the initial release of this feature needs | |
to either specify only the realpath version, or both versions.</p></div> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
Note that "../" is not special and will match literally, which is | |
unlikely what you want. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect2"> | |
<h3 id="_example">Example</h3> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code># Core variables | |
[core] | |
; Don't trust file modes | |
filemode = false | |
# Our diff algorithm | |
[diff] | |
external = /usr/local/bin/diff-wrapper | |
renames = true | |
[branch "devel"] | |
remote = origin | |
merge = refs/heads/devel | |
# Proxy settings | |
[core] | |
gitProxy="ssh" for "kernel.org" | |
gitProxy=default-proxy ; for the rest | |
[include] | |
path = /path/to/foo.inc ; include by absolute path | |
path = foo.inc ; find "foo.inc" relative to the current file | |
path = ~/foo.inc ; find "foo.inc" in your `$HOME` directory | |
; include if $GIT_DIR is /path/to/foo/.git | |
[includeIf "gitdir:/path/to/foo/.git"] | |
path = /path/to/foo.inc | |
; include for all repositories inside /path/to/group | |
[includeIf "gitdir:/path/to/group/"] | |
path = /path/to/foo.inc | |
; include for all repositories inside $HOME/to/group | |
[includeIf "gitdir:~/to/group/"] | |
path = /path/to/foo.inc | |
; relative paths are always relative to the including | |
; file (if the condition is true); their location is not | |
; affected by the condition | |
[includeIf "gitdir:/path/to/group/"] | |
path = foo.inc | |
; include only if we are in a worktree where foo-branch is | |
; currently checked out | |
[includeIf "onbranch:foo-branch"] | |
path = foo.inc</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect2"> | |
<h3 id="_values">Values</h3> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Values of many variables are treated as a simple string, but there | |
are variables that take values of specific types and there are rules | |
as to how to spell them.</p></div> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
boolean | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When a variable is said to take a boolean value, many | |
synonyms are accepted for <em>true</em> and <em>false</em>; these are all | |
case-insensitive. | |
</p> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
true | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Boolean true literals are <code>yes</code>, <code>on</code>, <code>true</code>, | |
and <code>1</code>. Also, a variable defined without <code>= <value></code> | |
is taken as true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
false | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Boolean false literals are <code>no</code>, <code>off</code>, <code>false</code>, | |
<code>0</code> and the empty string. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When converting a value to its canonical form using the <code>--type=bool</code> type | |
specifier, <em>git config</em> will ensure that the output is "true" or | |
"false" (spelled in lowercase).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
integer | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The value for many variables that specify various sizes can | |
be suffixed with <code>k</code>, <code>M</code>,… to mean "scale the number by | |
1024", "by 1024x1024", etc. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The value for a variable that takes a color is a list of | |
colors (at most two, one for foreground and one for background) | |
and attributes (as many as you want), separated by spaces. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The basic colors accepted are <code>normal</code>, <code>black</code>, <code>red</code>, <code>green</code>, <code>yellow</code>, | |
<code>blue</code>, <code>magenta</code>, <code>cyan</code> and <code>white</code>. The first color given is the | |
foreground; the second is the background. All the basic colors except | |
<code>normal</code> have a bright variant that can be specified by prefixing the | |
color with <code>bright</code>, like <code>brightred</code>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Colors may also be given as numbers between 0 and 255; these use ANSI | |
256-color mode (but note that not all terminals may support this). If | |
your terminal supports it, you may also specify 24-bit RGB values as | |
hex, like <code>#ff0ab3</code>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The accepted attributes are <code>bold</code>, <code>dim</code>, <code>ul</code>, <code>blink</code>, <code>reverse</code>, | |
<code>italic</code>, and <code>strike</code> (for crossed-out or "strikethrough" letters). | |
The position of any attributes with respect to the colors | |
(before, after, or in between), doesn’t matter. Specific attributes may | |
be turned off by prefixing them with <code>no</code> or <code>no-</code> (e.g., <code>noreverse</code>, | |
<code>no-ul</code>, etc).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>An empty color string produces no color effect at all. This can be used | |
to avoid coloring specific elements without disabling color entirely.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For git’s pre-defined color slots, the attributes are meant to be reset | |
at the beginning of each item in the colored output. So setting | |
<code>color.decorate.branch</code> to <code>black</code> will paint that branch name in a | |
plain <code>black</code>, even if the previous thing on the same output line (e.g. | |
opening parenthesis before the list of branch names in <code>log --decorate</code> | |
output) is set to be painted with <code>bold</code> or some other attribute. | |
However, custom log formats may do more complicated and layered | |
coloring, and the negated forms may be useful there.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pathname | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A variable that takes a pathname value can be given a | |
string that begins with "<code>~/</code>" or "<code>~user/</code>", and the usual | |
tilde expansion happens to such a string: <code>~/</code> | |
is expanded to the value of <code>$HOME</code>, and <code>~user/</code> to the | |
specified user’s home directory. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a path starts with <code>%(prefix)/</code>, the remainder is interpreted as a | |
path relative to Git’s "runtime prefix", i.e. relative to the location | |
where Git itself was installed. For example, <code>%(prefix)/bin/</code> refers to | |
the directory in which the Git executable itself lives. If Git was | |
compiled without runtime prefix support, the compiled-in prefix will be | |
subsituted instead. In the unlikely event that a literal path needs to | |
be specified that should <em>not</em> be expanded, it needs to be prefixed by | |
<code>./</code>, like so: <code>./%(prefix)/bin</code>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect2"> | |
<h3 id="_variables">Variables</h3> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that this list is non-comprehensive and not necessarily complete. | |
For command-specific variables, you will find a more detailed description | |
in the appropriate manual page.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Other git-related tools may and do use their own variables. When | |
inventing new variables for use in your own tool, make sure their | |
names do not conflict with those that are used by Git itself and | |
other popular tools, and describe them in your documentation.</p></div> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
advice.* | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
These variables control various optional help messages designed to | |
aid new users. All <em>advice.*</em> variables default to <em>true</em>, and you | |
can tell Git that you do not need help by setting these to <em>false</em>: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetchShowForcedUpdates | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown when <a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a> takes a long time | |
to calculate forced updates after ref updates, or to warn | |
that the check is disabled. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pushUpdateRejected | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set this variable to <em>false</em> if you want to disable | |
<em>pushNonFFCurrent</em>, <em>pushNonFFMatching</em>, <em>pushAlreadyExists</em>, | |
<em>pushFetchFirst</em>, <em>pushNeedsForce</em>, and <em>pushRefNeedsUpdate</em> | |
simultaneously. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pushNonFFCurrent | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown when <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a> fails due to a | |
non-fast-forward update to the current branch. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pushNonFFMatching | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown when you ran <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a> and pushed | |
<em>matching refs</em> explicitly (i.e. you used <em>:</em>, or | |
specified a refspec that isn’t your current branch) and | |
it resulted in a non-fast-forward error. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pushAlreadyExists | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Shown when <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a> rejects an update that | |
does not qualify for fast-forwarding (e.g., a tag.) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pushFetchFirst | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Shown when <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a> rejects an update that | |
tries to overwrite a remote ref that points at an | |
object we do not have. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pushNeedsForce | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Shown when <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a> rejects an update that | |
tries to overwrite a remote ref that points at an | |
object that is not a commit-ish, or make the remote | |
ref point at an object that is not a commit-ish. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pushUnqualifiedRefname | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Shown when <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a> gives up trying to | |
guess based on the source and destination refs what | |
remote ref namespace the source belongs in, but where | |
we can still suggest that the user push to either | |
refs/heads/* or refs/tags/* based on the type of the | |
source object. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pushRefNeedsUpdate | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Shown when <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a> rejects a forced update of | |
a branch when its remote-tracking ref has updates that we | |
do not have locally. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
skippedCherryPicks | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Shown when <a href="git-rebase.html">git-rebase(1)</a> skips a commit that has already | |
been cherry-picked onto the upstream branch. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
statusAheadBehind | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Shown when <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> computes the ahead/behind | |
counts for a local ref compared to its remote tracking ref, | |
and that calculation takes longer than expected. Will not | |
appear if <code>status.aheadBehind</code> is false or the option | |
<code>--no-ahead-behind</code> is given. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
statusHints | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Show directions on how to proceed from the current | |
state in the output of <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a>, in | |
the template shown when writing commit messages in | |
<a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a>, and in the help message shown | |
by <a href="git-switch.html">git-switch(1)</a> or | |
<a href="git-checkout.html">git-checkout(1)</a> when switching branch. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
statusUoption | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advise to consider using the <code>-u</code> option to <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> | |
when the command takes more than 2 seconds to enumerate untracked | |
files. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
commitBeforeMerge | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown when <a href="git-merge.html">git-merge(1)</a> refuses to | |
merge to avoid overwriting local changes. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
resetQuiet | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice to consider using the <code>--quiet</code> option to <a href="git-reset.html">git-reset(1)</a> | |
when the command takes more than 2 seconds to enumerate unstaged | |
changes after reset. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
resolveConflict | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown by various commands when conflicts | |
prevent the operation from being performed. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sequencerInUse | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown when a sequencer command is already in progress. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
implicitIdentity | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice on how to set your identity configuration when | |
your information is guessed from the system username and | |
domain name. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
detachedHead | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown when you used | |
<a href="git-switch.html">git-switch(1)</a> or <a href="git-checkout.html">git-checkout(1)</a> | |
to move to the detach HEAD state, to instruct how to | |
create a local branch after the fact. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
checkoutAmbiguousRemoteBranchName | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown when the argument to | |
<a href="git-checkout.html">git-checkout(1)</a> and <a href="git-switch.html">git-switch(1)</a> | |
ambiguously resolves to a | |
remote tracking branch on more than one remote in | |
situations where an unambiguous argument would have | |
otherwise caused a remote-tracking branch to be | |
checked out. See the <code>checkout.defaultRemote</code> | |
configuration variable for how to set a given remote | |
to used by default in some situations where this | |
advice would be printed. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
amWorkDir | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice that shows the location of the patch file when | |
<a href="git-am.html">git-am(1)</a> fails to apply it. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rmHints | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
In case of failure in the output of <a href="git-rm.html">git-rm(1)</a>, | |
show directions on how to proceed from the current state. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
addEmbeddedRepo | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice on what to do when you’ve accidentally added one | |
git repo inside of another. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
ignoredHook | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown if a hook is ignored because the hook is not | |
set as executable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
waitingForEditor | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Print a message to the terminal whenever Git is waiting for | |
editor input from the user. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
nestedTag | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown if a user attempts to recursively tag a tag object. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submoduleAlternateErrorStrategyDie | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown when a submodule.alternateErrorStrategy option | |
configured to "die" causes a fatal error. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
addIgnoredFile | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown if a user attempts to add an ignored file to | |
the index. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
addEmptyPathspec | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown if a user runs the add command without providing | |
the pathspec parameter. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
updateSparsePath | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Advice shown when either <a href="git-add.html">git-add(1)</a> or <a href="git-rm.html">git-rm(1)</a> | |
is asked to update index entries outside the current sparse | |
checkout. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.fileMode | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Tells Git if the executable bit of files in the working tree | |
is to be honored. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Some filesystems lose the executable bit when a file that is | |
marked as executable is checked out, or checks out a | |
non-executable file with executable bit on. | |
<a href="git-clone.html">git-clone(1)</a> or <a href="git-init.html">git-init(1)</a> probe the filesystem | |
to see if it handles the executable bit correctly | |
and this variable is automatically set as necessary.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>A repository, however, may be on a filesystem that handles | |
the filemode correctly, and this variable is set to <em>true</em> | |
when created, but later may be made accessible from another | |
environment that loses the filemode (e.g. exporting ext4 via | |
CIFS mount, visiting a Cygwin created repository with | |
Git for Windows or Eclipse). | |
In such a case it may be necessary to set this variable to <em>false</em>. | |
See <a href="git-update-index.html">git-update-index(1)</a>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The default is true (when core.filemode is not specified in the config file).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.hideDotFiles | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
(Windows-only) If true, mark newly-created directories and files whose | |
name starts with a dot as hidden. If <em>dotGitOnly</em>, only the <code>.git/</code> | |
directory is hidden, but no other files starting with a dot. The | |
default mode is <em>dotGitOnly</em>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.ignoreCase | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Internal variable which enables various workarounds to enable | |
Git to work better on filesystems that are not case sensitive, | |
like APFS, HFS+, FAT, NTFS, etc. For example, if a directory listing | |
finds "makefile" when Git expects "Makefile", Git will assume | |
it is really the same file, and continue to remember it as | |
"Makefile". | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The default is false, except <a href="git-clone.html">git-clone(1)</a> or <a href="git-init.html">git-init(1)</a> | |
will probe and set core.ignoreCase true if appropriate when the repository | |
is created.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Git relies on the proper configuration of this variable for your operating | |
and file system. Modifying this value may result in unexpected behavior.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.precomposeUnicode | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This option is only used by Mac OS implementation of Git. | |
When core.precomposeUnicode=true, Git reverts the unicode decomposition | |
of filenames done by Mac OS. This is useful when sharing a repository | |
between Mac OS and Linux or Windows. | |
(Git for Windows 1.7.10 or higher is needed, or Git under cygwin 1.7). | |
When false, file names are handled fully transparent by Git, | |
which is backward compatible with older versions of Git. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.protectHFS | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, do not allow checkout of paths that would | |
be considered equivalent to <code>.git</code> on an HFS+ filesystem. | |
Defaults to <code>true</code> on Mac OS, and <code>false</code> elsewhere. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.protectNTFS | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, do not allow checkout of paths that would | |
cause problems with the NTFS filesystem, e.g. conflict with | |
8.3 "short" names. | |
Defaults to <code>true</code> on Windows, and <code>false</code> elsewhere. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.fsmonitor | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set, the value of this variable is used as a command which | |
will identify all files that may have changed since the | |
requested date/time. This information is used to speed up git by | |
avoiding unnecessary processing of files that have not changed. | |
See the "fsmonitor-watchman" section of <a href="githooks.html">githooks(5)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.fsmonitorHookVersion | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Sets the version of hook that is to be used when calling fsmonitor. | |
There are currently versions 1 and 2. When this is not set, | |
version 2 will be tried first and if it fails then version 1 | |
will be tried. Version 1 uses a timestamp as input to determine | |
which files have changes since that time but some monitors | |
like watchman have race conditions when used with a timestamp. | |
Version 2 uses an opaque string so that the monitor can return | |
something that can be used to determine what files have changed | |
without race conditions. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.trustctime | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If false, the ctime differences between the index and the | |
working tree are ignored; useful when the inode change time | |
is regularly modified by something outside Git (file system | |
crawlers and some backup systems). | |
See <a href="git-update-index.html">git-update-index(1)</a>. True by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.splitIndex | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, the split-index feature of the index will be used. | |
See <a href="git-update-index.html">git-update-index(1)</a>. False by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.untrackedCache | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Determines what to do about the untracked cache feature of the | |
index. It will be kept, if this variable is unset or set to | |
<code>keep</code>. It will automatically be added if set to <code>true</code>. And | |
it will automatically be removed, if set to <code>false</code>. Before | |
setting it to <code>true</code>, you should check that mtime is working | |
properly on your system. | |
See <a href="git-update-index.html">git-update-index(1)</a>. <code>keep</code> by default, unless | |
<code>feature.manyFiles</code> is enabled which sets this setting to | |
<code>true</code> by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.checkStat | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When missing or is set to <code>default</code>, many fields in the stat | |
structure are checked to detect if a file has been modified | |
since Git looked at it. When this configuration variable is | |
set to <code>minimal</code>, sub-second part of mtime and ctime, the | |
uid and gid of the owner of the file, the inode number (and | |
the device number, if Git was compiled to use it), are | |
excluded from the check among these fields, leaving only the | |
whole-second part of mtime (and ctime, if <code>core.trustCtime</code> | |
is set) and the filesize to be checked. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>There are implementations of Git that do not leave usable values in | |
some fields (e.g. JGit); by excluding these fields from the | |
comparison, the <code>minimal</code> mode may help interoperability when the | |
same repository is used by these other systems at the same time.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.quotePath | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Commands that output paths (e.g. <em>ls-files</em>, <em>diff</em>), will | |
quote "unusual" characters in the pathname by enclosing the | |
pathname in double-quotes and escaping those characters with | |
backslashes in the same way C escapes control characters (e.g. | |
<code>\t</code> for TAB, <code>\n</code> for LF, <code>\\</code> for backslash) or bytes with | |
values larger than 0x80 (e.g. octal <code>\302\265</code> for "micro" in | |
UTF-8). If this variable is set to false, bytes higher than | |
0x80 are not considered "unusual" any more. Double-quotes, | |
backslash and control characters are always escaped regardless | |
of the setting of this variable. A simple space character is | |
not considered "unusual". Many commands can output pathnames | |
completely verbatim using the <code>-z</code> option. The default value | |
is true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.eol | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Sets the line ending type to use in the working directory for | |
files that are marked as text (either by having the <code>text</code> | |
attribute set, or by having <code>text=auto</code> and Git auto-detecting | |
the contents as text). | |
Alternatives are <em>lf</em>, <em>crlf</em> and <em>native</em>, which uses the platform’s | |
native line ending. The default value is <code>native</code>. See | |
<a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for more information on end-of-line | |
conversion. Note that this value is ignored if <code>core.autocrlf</code> | |
is set to <code>true</code> or <code>input</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.safecrlf | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, makes Git check if converting <code>CRLF</code> is reversible when | |
end-of-line conversion is active. Git will verify if a command | |
modifies a file in the work tree either directly or indirectly. | |
For example, committing a file followed by checking out the | |
same file should yield the original file in the work tree. If | |
this is not the case for the current setting of | |
<code>core.autocrlf</code>, Git will reject the file. The variable can | |
be set to "warn", in which case Git will only warn about an | |
irreversible conversion but continue the operation. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>CRLF conversion bears a slight chance of corrupting data. | |
When it is enabled, Git will convert CRLF to LF during commit and LF to | |
CRLF during checkout. A file that contains a mixture of LF and | |
CRLF before the commit cannot be recreated by Git. For text | |
files this is the right thing to do: it corrects line endings | |
such that we have only LF line endings in the repository. | |
But for binary files that are accidentally classified as text the | |
conversion can corrupt data.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If you recognize such corruption early you can easily fix it by | |
setting the conversion type explicitly in .gitattributes. Right | |
after committing you still have the original file in your work | |
tree and this file is not yet corrupted. You can explicitly tell | |
Git that this file is binary and Git will handle the file | |
appropriately.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Unfortunately, the desired effect of cleaning up text files with | |
mixed line endings and the undesired effect of corrupting binary | |
files cannot be distinguished. In both cases CRLFs are removed | |
in an irreversible way. For text files this is the right thing | |
to do because CRLFs are line endings, while for binary files | |
converting CRLFs corrupts data.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note, this safety check does not mean that a checkout will generate a | |
file identical to the original file for a different setting of | |
<code>core.eol</code> and <code>core.autocrlf</code>, but only for the current one. For | |
example, a text file with <code>LF</code> would be accepted with <code>core.eol=lf</code> | |
and could later be checked out with <code>core.eol=crlf</code>, in which case the | |
resulting file would contain <code>CRLF</code>, although the original file | |
contained <code>LF</code>. However, in both work trees the line endings would be | |
consistent, that is either all <code>LF</code> or all <code>CRLF</code>, but never mixed. A | |
file with mixed line endings would be reported by the <code>core.safecrlf</code> | |
mechanism.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.autocrlf | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Setting this variable to "true" is the same as setting | |
the <code>text</code> attribute to "auto" on all files and core.eol to "crlf". | |
Set to true if you want to have <code>CRLF</code> line endings in your | |
working directory and the repository has LF line endings. | |
This variable can be set to <em>input</em>, | |
in which case no output conversion is performed. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.checkRoundtripEncoding | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A comma and/or whitespace separated list of encodings that Git | |
performs UTF-8 round trip checks on if they are used in an | |
<code>working-tree-encoding</code> attribute (see <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a>). | |
The default value is <code>SHIFT-JIS</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.symlinks | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If false, symbolic links are checked out as small plain files that | |
contain the link text. <a href="git-update-index.html">git-update-index(1)</a> and | |
<a href="git-add.html">git-add(1)</a> will not change the recorded type to regular | |
file. Useful on filesystems like FAT that do not support | |
symbolic links. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The default is true, except <a href="git-clone.html">git-clone(1)</a> or <a href="git-init.html">git-init(1)</a> | |
will probe and set core.symlinks false if appropriate when the repository | |
is created.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.gitProxy | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A "proxy command" to execute (as <em>command host port</em>) instead | |
of establishing direct connection to the remote server when | |
using the Git protocol for fetching. If the variable value is | |
in the "COMMAND for DOMAIN" format, the command is applied only | |
on hostnames ending with the specified domain string. This variable | |
may be set multiple times and is matched in the given order; | |
the first match wins. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_PROXY_COMMAND</code> environment variable | |
(which always applies universally, without the special "for" | |
handling).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The special string <code>none</code> can be used as the proxy command to | |
specify that no proxy be used for a given domain pattern. | |
This is useful for excluding servers inside a firewall from | |
proxy use, while defaulting to a common proxy for external domains.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.sshCommand | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If this variable is set, <code>git fetch</code> and <code>git push</code> will | |
use the specified command instead of <code>ssh</code> when they need to | |
connect to a remote system. The command is in the same form as | |
the <code>GIT_SSH_COMMAND</code> environment variable and is overridden | |
when the environment variable is set. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.ignoreStat | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, Git will avoid using lstat() calls to detect if files have | |
changed by setting the "assume-unchanged" bit for those tracked files | |
which it has updated identically in both the index and working tree. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When files are modified outside of Git, the user will need to stage | |
the modified files explicitly (e.g. see <em>Examples</em> section in | |
<a href="git-update-index.html">git-update-index(1)</a>). | |
Git will not normally detect changes to those files.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This is useful on systems where lstat() calls are very slow, such as | |
CIFS/Microsoft Windows.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>False by default.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.preferSymlinkRefs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Instead of the default "symref" format for HEAD | |
and other symbolic reference files, use symbolic links. | |
This is sometimes needed to work with old scripts that | |
expect HEAD to be a symbolic link. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.alternateRefsCommand | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When advertising tips of available history from an alternate, use the shell to | |
execute the specified command instead of <a href="git-for-each-ref.html">git-for-each-ref(1)</a>. The | |
first argument is the absolute path of the alternate. Output must contain one | |
hex object id per line (i.e., the same as produced by <code>git for-each-ref | |
--format='%(objectname)'</code>). | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that you cannot generally put <code>git for-each-ref</code> directly into the config | |
value, as it does not take a repository path as an argument (but you can wrap | |
the command above in a shell script).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.alternateRefsPrefixes | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When listing references from an alternate, list only references that begin | |
with the given prefix. Prefixes match as if they were given as arguments to | |
<a href="git-for-each-ref.html">git-for-each-ref(1)</a>. To list multiple prefixes, separate them with | |
whitespace. If <code>core.alternateRefsCommand</code> is set, setting | |
<code>core.alternateRefsPrefixes</code> has no effect. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.bare | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true this repository is assumed to be <em>bare</em> and has no | |
working directory associated with it. If this is the case a | |
number of commands that require a working directory will be | |
disabled, such as <a href="git-add.html">git-add(1)</a> or <a href="git-merge.html">git-merge(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This setting is automatically guessed by <a href="git-clone.html">git-clone(1)</a> or | |
<a href="git-init.html">git-init(1)</a> when the repository was created. By default a | |
repository that ends in "/.git" is assumed to be not bare (bare = | |
false), while all other repositories are assumed to be bare (bare | |
= true).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.worktree | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set the path to the root of the working tree. | |
If <code>GIT_COMMON_DIR</code> environment variable is set, core.worktree | |
is ignored and not used for determining the root of working tree. | |
This can be overridden by the <code>GIT_WORK_TREE</code> environment | |
variable and the <code>--work-tree</code> command-line option. | |
The value can be an absolute path or relative to the path to | |
the .git directory, which is either specified by --git-dir | |
or GIT_DIR, or automatically discovered. | |
If --git-dir or GIT_DIR is specified but none of | |
--work-tree, GIT_WORK_TREE and core.worktree is specified, | |
the current working directory is regarded as the top level | |
of your working tree. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that this variable is honored even when set in a configuration | |
file in a ".git" subdirectory of a directory and its value differs | |
from the latter directory (e.g. "/path/to/.git/config" has | |
core.worktree set to "/different/path"), which is most likely a | |
misconfiguration. Running Git commands in the "/path/to" directory will | |
still use "/different/path" as the root of the work tree and can cause | |
confusion unless you know what you are doing (e.g. you are creating a | |
read-only snapshot of the same index to a location different from the | |
repository’s usual working tree).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.logAllRefUpdates | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Enable the reflog. Updates to a ref <ref> is logged to the file | |
"<code>$GIT_DIR/logs/<ref></code>", by appending the new and old | |
SHA-1, the date/time and the reason of the update, but | |
only when the file exists. If this configuration | |
variable is set to <code>true</code>, missing "<code>$GIT_DIR/logs/<ref></code>" | |
file is automatically created for branch heads (i.e. under | |
<code>refs/heads/</code>), remote refs (i.e. under <code>refs/remotes/</code>), | |
note refs (i.e. under <code>refs/notes/</code>), and the symbolic ref <code>HEAD</code>. | |
If it is set to <code>always</code>, then a missing reflog is automatically | |
created for any ref under <code>refs/</code>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This information can be used to determine what commit | |
was the tip of a branch "2 days ago".</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This value is true by default in a repository that has | |
a working directory associated with it, and false by | |
default in a bare repository.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.repositoryFormatVersion | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Internal variable identifying the repository format and layout | |
version. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.sharedRepository | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When <em>group</em> (or <em>true</em>), the repository is made shareable between | |
several users in a group (making sure all the files and objects are | |
group-writable). When <em>all</em> (or <em>world</em> or <em>everybody</em>), the | |
repository will be readable by all users, additionally to being | |
group-shareable. When <em>umask</em> (or <em>false</em>), Git will use permissions | |
reported by umask(2). When <em>0xxx</em>, where <em>0xxx</em> is an octal number, | |
files in the repository will have this mode value. <em>0xxx</em> will override | |
user’s umask value (whereas the other options will only override | |
requested parts of the user’s umask value). Examples: <em>0660</em> will make | |
the repo read/write-able for the owner and group, but inaccessible to | |
others (equivalent to <em>group</em> unless umask is e.g. <em>0022</em>). <em>0640</em> is a | |
repository that is group-readable but not group-writable. | |
See <a href="git-init.html">git-init(1)</a>. False by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.warnAmbiguousRefs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, Git will warn you if the ref name you passed it is ambiguous | |
and might match multiple refs in the repository. True by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.compression | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
An integer -1..9, indicating a default compression level. | |
-1 is the zlib default. 0 means no compression, | |
and 1..9 are various speed/size tradeoffs, 9 being slowest. | |
If set, this provides a default to other compression variables, | |
such as <code>core.looseCompression</code> and <code>pack.compression</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.looseCompression | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
An integer -1..9, indicating the compression level for objects that | |
are not in a pack file. -1 is the zlib default. 0 means no | |
compression, and 1..9 are various speed/size tradeoffs, 9 being | |
slowest. If not set, defaults to core.compression. If that is | |
not set, defaults to 1 (best speed). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.packedGitWindowSize | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Number of bytes of a pack file to map into memory in a | |
single mapping operation. Larger window sizes may allow | |
your system to process a smaller number of large pack files | |
more quickly. Smaller window sizes will negatively affect | |
performance due to increased calls to the operating system’s | |
memory manager, but may improve performance when accessing | |
a large number of large pack files. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Default is 1 MiB if NO_MMAP was set at compile time, otherwise 32 | |
MiB on 32 bit platforms and 1 GiB on 64 bit platforms. This should | |
be reasonable for all users/operating systems. You probably do | |
not need to adjust this value.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Common unit suffixes of <em>k</em>, <em>m</em>, or <em>g</em> are supported.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.packedGitLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Maximum number of bytes to map simultaneously into memory | |
from pack files. If Git needs to access more than this many | |
bytes at once to complete an operation it will unmap existing | |
regions to reclaim virtual address space within the process. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Default is 256 MiB on 32 bit platforms and 32 TiB (effectively | |
unlimited) on 64 bit platforms. | |
This should be reasonable for all users/operating systems, except on | |
the largest projects. You probably do not need to adjust this value.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Common unit suffixes of <em>k</em>, <em>m</em>, or <em>g</em> are supported.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.deltaBaseCacheLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Maximum number of bytes per thread to reserve for caching base objects | |
that may be referenced by multiple deltified objects. By storing the | |
entire decompressed base objects in a cache Git is able | |
to avoid unpacking and decompressing frequently used base | |
objects multiple times. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Default is 96 MiB on all platforms. This should be reasonable | |
for all users/operating systems, except on the largest projects. | |
You probably do not need to adjust this value.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Common unit suffixes of <em>k</em>, <em>m</em>, or <em>g</em> are supported.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.bigFileThreshold | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Files larger than this size are stored deflated, without | |
attempting delta compression. Storing large files without | |
delta compression avoids excessive memory usage, at the | |
slight expense of increased disk usage. Additionally files | |
larger than this size are always treated as binary. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Default is 512 MiB on all platforms. This should be reasonable | |
for most projects as source code and other text files can still | |
be delta compressed, but larger binary media files won’t be.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Common unit suffixes of <em>k</em>, <em>m</em>, or <em>g</em> are supported.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.excludesFile | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the pathname to the file that contains patterns to | |
describe paths that are not meant to be tracked, in addition | |
to <code>.gitignore</code> (per-directory) and <code>.git/info/exclude</code>. | |
Defaults to <code>$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/git/ignore</code>. | |
If <code>$XDG_CONFIG_HOME</code> is either not set or empty, <code>$HOME/.config/git/ignore</code> | |
is used instead. See <a href="gitignore.html">gitignore(5)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.askPass | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Some commands (e.g. svn and http interfaces) that interactively | |
ask for a password can be told to use an external program given | |
via the value of this variable. Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_ASKPASS</code> | |
environment variable. If not set, fall back to the value of the | |
<code>SSH_ASKPASS</code> environment variable or, failing that, a simple password | |
prompt. The external program shall be given a suitable prompt as | |
command-line argument and write the password on its STDOUT. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.attributesFile | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
In addition to <code>.gitattributes</code> (per-directory) and | |
<code>.git/info/attributes</code>, Git looks into this file for attributes | |
(see <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a>). Path expansions are made the same | |
way as for <code>core.excludesFile</code>. Its default value is | |
<code>$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/git/attributes</code>. If <code>$XDG_CONFIG_HOME</code> is either not | |
set or empty, <code>$HOME/.config/git/attributes</code> is used instead. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.hooksPath | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default Git will look for your hooks in the | |
<code>$GIT_DIR/hooks</code> directory. Set this to different path, | |
e.g. <code>/etc/git/hooks</code>, and Git will try to find your hooks in | |
that directory, e.g. <code>/etc/git/hooks/pre-receive</code> instead of | |
in <code>$GIT_DIR/hooks/pre-receive</code>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The path can be either absolute or relative. A relative path is | |
taken as relative to the directory where the hooks are run (see | |
the "DESCRIPTION" section of <a href="githooks.html">githooks(5)</a>).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This configuration variable is useful in cases where you’d like to | |
centrally configure your Git hooks instead of configuring them on a | |
per-repository basis, or as a more flexible and centralized | |
alternative to having an <code>init.templateDir</code> where you’ve changed | |
default hooks.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.editor | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Commands such as <code>commit</code> and <code>tag</code> that let you edit | |
messages by launching an editor use the value of this | |
variable when it is set, and the environment variable | |
<code>GIT_EDITOR</code> is not set. See <a href="git-var.html">git-var(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.commentChar | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Commands such as <code>commit</code> and <code>tag</code> that let you edit | |
messages consider a line that begins with this character | |
commented, and removes them after the editor returns | |
(default <em>#</em>). | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If set to "auto", <code>git-commit</code> would select a character that is not | |
the beginning character of any line in existing commit messages.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.filesRefLockTimeout | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The length of time, in milliseconds, to retry when trying to | |
lock an individual reference. Value 0 means not to retry at | |
all; -1 means to try indefinitely. Default is 100 (i.e., | |
retry for 100ms). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.packedRefsTimeout | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The length of time, in milliseconds, to retry when trying to | |
lock the <code>packed-refs</code> file. Value 0 means not to retry at | |
all; -1 means to try indefinitely. Default is 1000 (i.e., | |
retry for 1 second). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.pager | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Text viewer for use by Git commands (e.g., <em>less</em>). The value | |
is meant to be interpreted by the shell. The order of preference | |
is the <code>$GIT_PAGER</code> environment variable, then <code>core.pager</code> | |
configuration, then <code>$PAGER</code>, and then the default chosen at | |
compile time (usually <em>less</em>). | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When the <code>LESS</code> environment variable is unset, Git sets it to <code>FRX</code> | |
(if <code>LESS</code> environment variable is set, Git does not change it at | |
all). If you want to selectively override Git’s default setting | |
for <code>LESS</code>, you can set <code>core.pager</code> to e.g. <code>less -S</code>. This will | |
be passed to the shell by Git, which will translate the final | |
command to <code>LESS=FRX less -S</code>. The environment does not set the | |
<code>S</code> option but the command line does, instructing less to truncate | |
long lines. Similarly, setting <code>core.pager</code> to <code>less -+F</code> will | |
deactivate the <code>F</code> option specified by the environment from the | |
command-line, deactivating the "quit if one screen" behavior of | |
<code>less</code>. One can specifically activate some flags for particular | |
commands: for example, setting <code>pager.blame</code> to <code>less -S</code> enables | |
line truncation only for <code>git blame</code>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Likewise, when the <code>LV</code> environment variable is unset, Git sets it | |
to <code>-c</code>. You can override this setting by exporting <code>LV</code> with | |
another value or setting <code>core.pager</code> to <code>lv +c</code>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.whitespace | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A comma separated list of common whitespace problems to | |
notice. <em>git diff</em> will use <code>color.diff.whitespace</code> to | |
highlight them, and <em>git apply --whitespace=error</em> will | |
consider them as errors. You can prefix <code>-</code> to disable | |
any of them (e.g. <code>-trailing-space</code>): | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>blank-at-eol</code> treats trailing whitespaces at the end of the line | |
as an error (enabled by default). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>space-before-tab</code> treats a space character that appears immediately | |
before a tab character in the initial indent part of the line as an | |
error (enabled by default). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>indent-with-non-tab</code> treats a line that is indented with space | |
characters instead of the equivalent tabs as an error (not enabled by | |
default). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>tab-in-indent</code> treats a tab character in the initial indent part of | |
the line as an error (not enabled by default). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>blank-at-eof</code> treats blank lines added at the end of file as an error | |
(enabled by default). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>trailing-space</code> is a short-hand to cover both <code>blank-at-eol</code> and | |
<code>blank-at-eof</code>. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>cr-at-eol</code> treats a carriage-return at the end of line as | |
part of the line terminator, i.e. with it, <code>trailing-space</code> | |
does not trigger if the character before such a carriage-return | |
is not a whitespace (not enabled by default). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>tabwidth=<n></code> tells how many character positions a tab occupies; this | |
is relevant for <code>indent-with-non-tab</code> and when Git fixes <code>tab-in-indent</code> | |
errors. The default tab width is 8. Allowed values are 1 to 63. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.fsyncObjectFiles | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This boolean will enable <em>fsync()</em> when writing object files. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This is a total waste of time and effort on a filesystem that orders | |
data writes properly, but can be useful for filesystems that do not use | |
journalling (traditional UNIX filesystems) or that only journal metadata | |
and not file contents (OS X’s HFS+, or Linux ext3 with "data=writeback").</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.preloadIndex | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Enable parallel index preload for operations like <em>git diff</em> | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This can speed up operations like <em>git diff</em> and <em>git status</em> especially | |
on filesystems like NFS that have weak caching semantics and thus | |
relatively high IO latencies. When enabled, Git will do the | |
index comparison to the filesystem data in parallel, allowing | |
overlapping IO’s. Defaults to true.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.unsetenvvars | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Windows-only: comma-separated list of environment variables' | |
names that need to be unset before spawning any other process. | |
Defaults to <code>PERL5LIB</code> to account for the fact that Git for | |
Windows insists on using its own Perl interpreter. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.restrictinheritedhandles | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Windows-only: override whether spawned processes inherit only standard | |
file handles (<code>stdin</code>, <code>stdout</code> and <code>stderr</code>) or all handles. Can be | |
<code>auto</code>, <code>true</code> or <code>false</code>. Defaults to <code>auto</code>, which means <code>true</code> on | |
Windows 7 and later, and <code>false</code> on older Windows versions. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.createObject | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
You can set this to <em>link</em>, in which case a hardlink followed by | |
a delete of the source are used to make sure that object creation | |
will not overwrite existing objects. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>On some file system/operating system combinations, this is unreliable. | |
Set this config setting to <em>rename</em> there; However, This will remove the | |
check that makes sure that existing object files will not get overwritten.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.notesRef | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When showing commit messages, also show notes which are stored in | |
the given ref. The ref must be fully qualified. If the given | |
ref does not exist, it is not an error but means that no | |
notes should be printed. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This setting defaults to "refs/notes/commits", and it can be overridden by | |
the <code>GIT_NOTES_REF</code> environment variable. See <a href="git-notes.html">git-notes(1)</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.commitGraph | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, then git will read the commit-graph file (if it exists) | |
to parse the graph structure of commits. Defaults to true. See | |
<a href="git-commit-graph.html">git-commit-graph(1)</a> for more information. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.useReplaceRefs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to <code>false</code>, behave as if the <code>--no-replace-objects</code> | |
option was given on the command line. See <a href="git.html">git(1)</a> and | |
<a href="git-replace.html">git-replace(1)</a> for more information. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.multiPackIndex | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use the multi-pack-index file to track multiple packfiles using a | |
single index. See <a href="git-multi-pack-index.html">git-multi-pack-index(1)</a> for more | |
information. Defaults to true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.sparseCheckout | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Enable "sparse checkout" feature. See <a href="git-sparse-checkout.html">git-sparse-checkout(1)</a> | |
for more information. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.sparseCheckoutCone | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Enables the "cone mode" of the sparse checkout feature. When the | |
sparse-checkout file contains a limited set of patterns, then this | |
mode provides significant performance advantages. See | |
<a href="git-sparse-checkout.html">git-sparse-checkout(1)</a> for more information. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
core.abbrev | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set the length object names are abbreviated to. If | |
unspecified or set to "auto", an appropriate value is | |
computed based on the approximate number of packed objects | |
in your repository, which hopefully is enough for | |
abbreviated object names to stay unique for some time. | |
If set to "no", no abbreviation is made and the object names | |
are shown in their full length. | |
The minimum length is 4. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
add.ignoreErrors | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
add.ignore-errors (deprecated) | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Tells <em>git add</em> to continue adding files when some files cannot be | |
added due to indexing errors. Equivalent to the <code>--ignore-errors</code> | |
option of <a href="git-add.html">git-add(1)</a>. <code>add.ignore-errors</code> is deprecated, | |
as it does not follow the usual naming convention for configuration | |
variables. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
add.interactive.useBuiltin | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
[EXPERIMENTAL] Set to <code>true</code> to use the experimental built-in | |
implementation of the interactive version of <a href="git-add.html">git-add(1)</a> | |
instead of the Perl script version. Is <code>false</code> by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
alias.* | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Command aliases for the <a href="git.html">git(1)</a> command wrapper - e.g. | |
after defining <code>alias.last = cat-file commit HEAD</code>, the invocation | |
<code>git last</code> is equivalent to <code>git cat-file commit HEAD</code>. To avoid | |
confusion and troubles with script usage, aliases that | |
hide existing Git commands are ignored. Arguments are split by | |
spaces, the usual shell quoting and escaping is supported. | |
A quote pair or a backslash can be used to quote them. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that the first word of an alias does not necessarily have to be a | |
command. It can be a command-line option that will be passed into the | |
invocation of <code>git</code>. In particular, this is useful when used with <code>-c</code> | |
to pass in one-time configurations or <code>-p</code> to force pagination. For example, | |
<code>loud-rebase = -c commit.verbose=true rebase</code> can be defined such that | |
running <code>git loud-rebase</code> would be equivalent to | |
<code>git -c commit.verbose=true rebase</code>. Also, <code>ps = -p status</code> would be a | |
helpful alias since <code>git ps</code> would paginate the output of <code>git status</code> | |
where the original command does not.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the alias expansion is prefixed with an exclamation point, | |
it will be treated as a shell command. For example, defining | |
<code>alias.new = !gitk --all --not ORIG_HEAD</code>, the invocation | |
<code>git new</code> is equivalent to running the shell command | |
<code>gitk --all --not ORIG_HEAD</code>. Note that shell commands will be | |
executed from the top-level directory of a repository, which may | |
not necessarily be the current directory. | |
<code>GIT_PREFIX</code> is set as returned by running <code>git rev-parse --show-prefix</code> | |
from the original current directory. See <a href="git-rev-parse.html">git-rev-parse(1)</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
am.keepcr | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, git-am will call git-mailsplit for patches in mbox format | |
with parameter <code>--keep-cr</code>. In this case git-mailsplit will | |
not remove <code>\r</code> from lines ending with <code>\r\n</code>. Can be overridden | |
by giving <code>--no-keep-cr</code> from the command line. | |
See <a href="git-am.html">git-am(1)</a>, <a href="git-mailsplit.html">git-mailsplit(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
am.threeWay | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default, <code>git am</code> will fail if the patch does not apply cleanly. When | |
set to true, this setting tells <code>git am</code> to fall back on 3-way merge if | |
the patch records the identity of blobs it is supposed to apply to and | |
we have those blobs available locally (equivalent to giving the <code>--3way</code> | |
option from the command line). Defaults to <code>false</code>. | |
See <a href="git-am.html">git-am(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
apply.ignoreWhitespace | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to <em>change</em>, tells <em>git apply</em> to ignore changes in | |
whitespace, in the same way as the <code>--ignore-space-change</code> | |
option. | |
When set to one of: no, none, never, false tells <em>git apply</em> to | |
respect all whitespace differences. | |
See <a href="git-apply.html">git-apply(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
apply.whitespace | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Tells <em>git apply</em> how to handle whitespaces, in the same way | |
as the <code>--whitespace</code> option. See <a href="git-apply.html">git-apply(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
blame.blankBoundary | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Show blank commit object name for boundary commits in | |
<a href="git-blame.html">git-blame(1)</a>. This option defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
blame.coloring | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This determines the coloring scheme to be applied to blame | |
output. It can be <em>repeatedLines</em>, <em>highlightRecent</em>, | |
or <em>none</em> which is the default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
blame.date | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the format used to output dates in <a href="git-blame.html">git-blame(1)</a>. | |
If unset the iso format is used. For supported values, | |
see the discussion of the <code>--date</code> option at <a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
blame.showEmail | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Show the author email instead of author name in <a href="git-blame.html">git-blame(1)</a>. | |
This option defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
blame.showRoot | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Do not treat root commits as boundaries in <a href="git-blame.html">git-blame(1)</a>. | |
This option defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
blame.ignoreRevsFile | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Ignore revisions listed in the file, one unabbreviated object name per | |
line, in <a href="git-blame.html">git-blame(1)</a>. Whitespace and comments beginning with | |
<code>#</code> are ignored. This option may be repeated multiple times. Empty | |
file names will reset the list of ignored revisions. This option will | |
be handled before the command line option <code>--ignore-revs-file</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
blame.markUnblamableLines | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Mark lines that were changed by an ignored revision that we could not | |
attribute to another commit with a <em>*</em> in the output of | |
<a href="git-blame.html">git-blame(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
blame.markIgnoredLines | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Mark lines that were changed by an ignored revision that we attributed to | |
another commit with a <em>?</em> in the output of <a href="git-blame.html">git-blame(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
branch.autoSetupMerge | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Tells <em>git branch</em>, <em>git switch</em> and <em>git checkout</em> to set up new branches | |
so that <a href="git-pull.html">git-pull(1)</a> will appropriately merge from the | |
starting point branch. Note that even if this option is not set, | |
this behavior can be chosen per-branch using the <code>--track</code> | |
and <code>--no-track</code> options. The valid settings are: <code>false</code> — no | |
automatic setup is done; <code>true</code> — automatic setup is done when the | |
starting point is a remote-tracking branch; <code>always</code> —  automatic setup is done when the starting point is either a | |
local branch or remote-tracking | |
branch. This option defaults to true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
branch.autoSetupRebase | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When a new branch is created with <em>git branch</em>, <em>git switch</em> or <em>git checkout</em> | |
that tracks another branch, this variable tells Git to set | |
up pull to rebase instead of merge (see "branch.<name>.rebase"). | |
When <code>never</code>, rebase is never automatically set to true. | |
When <code>local</code>, rebase is set to true for tracked branches of | |
other local branches. | |
When <code>remote</code>, rebase is set to true for tracked branches of | |
remote-tracking branches. | |
When <code>always</code>, rebase will be set to true for all tracking | |
branches. | |
See "branch.autoSetupMerge" for details on how to set up a | |
branch to track another branch. | |
This option defaults to never. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
branch.sort | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This variable controls the sort ordering of branches when displayed by | |
<a href="git-branch.html">git-branch(1)</a>. Without the "--sort=<value>" option provided, the | |
value of this variable will be used as the default. | |
See <a href="git-for-each-ref.html">git-for-each-ref(1)</a> field names for valid values. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
branch.<name>.remote | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When on branch <name>, it tells <em>git fetch</em> and <em>git push</em> | |
which remote to fetch from/push to. The remote to push to | |
may be overridden with <code>remote.pushDefault</code> (for all branches). | |
The remote to push to, for the current branch, may be further | |
overridden by <code>branch.<name>.pushRemote</code>. If no remote is | |
configured, or if you are not on any branch, it defaults to | |
<code>origin</code> for fetching and <code>remote.pushDefault</code> for pushing. | |
Additionally, <code>.</code> (a period) is the current local repository | |
(a dot-repository), see <code>branch.<name>.merge</code>'s final note below. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
branch.<name>.pushRemote | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When on branch <name>, it overrides <code>branch.<name>.remote</code> for | |
pushing. It also overrides <code>remote.pushDefault</code> for pushing | |
from branch <name>. When you pull from one place (e.g. your | |
upstream) and push to another place (e.g. your own publishing | |
repository), you would want to set <code>remote.pushDefault</code> to | |
specify the remote to push to for all branches, and use this | |
option to override it for a specific branch. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
branch.<name>.merge | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Defines, together with branch.<name>.remote, the upstream branch | |
for the given branch. It tells <em>git fetch</em>/<em>git pull</em>/<em>git rebase</em> which | |
branch to merge and can also affect <em>git push</em> (see push.default). | |
When in branch <name>, it tells <em>git fetch</em> the default | |
refspec to be marked for merging in FETCH_HEAD. The value is | |
handled like the remote part of a refspec, and must match a | |
ref which is fetched from the remote given by | |
"branch.<name>.remote". | |
The merge information is used by <em>git pull</em> (which at first calls | |
<em>git fetch</em>) to lookup the default branch for merging. Without | |
this option, <em>git pull</em> defaults to merge the first refspec fetched. | |
Specify multiple values to get an octopus merge. | |
If you wish to setup <em>git pull</em> so that it merges into <name> from | |
another branch in the local repository, you can point | |
branch.<name>.merge to the desired branch, and use the relative path | |
setting <code>.</code> (a period) for branch.<name>.remote. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
branch.<name>.mergeOptions | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Sets default options for merging into branch <name>. The syntax and | |
supported options are the same as those of <a href="git-merge.html">git-merge(1)</a>, but | |
option values containing whitespace characters are currently not | |
supported. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
branch.<name>.rebase | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When true, rebase the branch <name> on top of the fetched branch, | |
instead of merging the default branch from the default remote when | |
"git pull" is run. See "pull.rebase" for doing this in a non | |
branch-specific manner. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When <code>merges</code> (or just <em>m</em>), pass the <code>--rebase-merges</code> option to <em>git rebase</em> | |
so that the local merge commits are included in the rebase (see | |
<a href="git-rebase.html">git-rebase(1)</a> for details).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When <code>preserve</code> (or just <em>p</em>, deprecated in favor of <code>merges</code>), also pass | |
<code>--preserve-merges</code> along to <em>git rebase</em> so that locally committed merge | |
commits will not be flattened by running <em>git pull</em>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When the value is <code>interactive</code> (or just <em>i</em>), the rebase is run in interactive | |
mode.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p><strong>NOTE</strong>: this is a possibly dangerous operation; do <strong>not</strong> use | |
it unless you understand the implications (see <a href="git-rebase.html">git-rebase(1)</a> | |
for details).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
branch.<name>.description | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Branch description, can be edited with | |
<code>git branch --edit-description</code>. Branch description is | |
automatically added in the format-patch cover letter or | |
request-pull summary. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
browser.<tool>.cmd | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the command to invoke the specified browser. The | |
specified command is evaluated in shell with the URLs passed | |
as arguments. (See <a href="git-web--browse.html">git-web--browse(1)</a>.) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
browser.<tool>.path | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Override the path for the given tool that may be used to | |
browse HTML help (see <code>-w</code> option in <a href="git-help.html">git-help(1)</a>) or a | |
working repository in gitweb (see <a href="git-instaweb.html">git-instaweb(1)</a>). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
checkout.defaultRemote | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When you run <code>git checkout <something></code> | |
or <code>git switch <something></code> and only have one | |
remote, it may implicitly fall back on checking out and | |
tracking e.g. <code>origin/<something></code>. This stops working as soon | |
as you have more than one remote with a <code><something></code> | |
reference. This setting allows for setting the name of a | |
preferred remote that should always win when it comes to | |
disambiguation. The typical use-case is to set this to | |
<code>origin</code>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Currently this is used by <a href="git-switch.html">git-switch(1)</a> and | |
<a href="git-checkout.html">git-checkout(1)</a> when <code>git checkout <something></code> | |
or <code>git switch <something></code> | |
will checkout the <code><something></code> branch on another remote, | |
and by <a href="git-worktree.html">git-worktree(1)</a> when <code>git worktree add</code> refers to a | |
remote branch. This setting might be used for other checkout-like | |
commands or functionality in the future.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
checkout.guess | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Provides the default value for the <code>--guess</code> or <code>--no-guess</code> | |
option in <code>git checkout</code> and <code>git switch</code>. See | |
<a href="git-switch.html">git-switch(1)</a> and <a href="git-checkout.html">git-checkout(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
checkout.workers | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The number of parallel workers to use when updating the working tree. | |
The default is one, i.e. sequential execution. If set to a value less | |
than one, Git will use as many workers as the number of logical cores | |
available. This setting and <code>checkout.thresholdForParallelism</code> affect | |
all commands that perform checkout. E.g. checkout, clone, reset, | |
sparse-checkout, etc. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note: parallel checkout usually delivers better performance for repositories | |
located on SSDs or over NFS. For repositories on spinning disks and/or machines | |
with a small number of cores, the default sequential checkout often performs | |
better. The size and compression level of a repository might also influence how | |
well the parallel version performs.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
checkout.thresholdForParallelism | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When running parallel checkout with a small number of files, the cost | |
of subprocess spawning and inter-process communication might outweigh | |
the parallelization gains. This setting allows to define the minimum | |
number of files for which parallel checkout should be attempted. The | |
default is 100. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
clean.requireForce | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to make git-clean do nothing unless given -f, | |
-i or -n. Defaults to true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
clone.defaultRemoteName | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The name of the remote to create when cloning a repository. Defaults to | |
<code>origin</code>, and can be overridden by passing the <code>--origin</code> command-line | |
option to <a href="git-clone.html">git-clone(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
clone.rejectShallow | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Reject to clone a repository if it is a shallow one, can be overridden by | |
passing option <code>--reject-shallow</code> in command line. See <a href="git-clone.html">git-clone(1)</a> | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.advice | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to enable/disable color in hints (e.g. when a push | |
failed, see <code>advice.*</code> for a list). May be set to <code>always</code>, | |
<code>false</code> (or <code>never</code>) or <code>auto</code> (or <code>true</code>), in which case colors | |
are used only when the error output goes to a terminal. If | |
unset, then the value of <code>color.ui</code> is used (<code>auto</code> by default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.advice.hint | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color for hints. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.blame.highlightRecent | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This can be used to color the metadata of a blame line depending | |
on age of the line. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This setting should be set to a comma-separated list of color and date settings, | |
starting and ending with a color, the dates should be set from oldest to newest. | |
The metadata will be colored given the colors if the line was introduced | |
before the given timestamp, overwriting older timestamped colors.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Instead of an absolute timestamp relative timestamps work as well, e.g. | |
2.weeks.ago is valid to address anything older than 2 weeks.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>It defaults to <em>blue,12 month ago,white,1 month ago,red</em>, which colors | |
everything older than one year blue, recent changes between one month and | |
one year old are kept white, and lines introduced within the last month are | |
colored red.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.blame.repeatedLines | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use the customized color for the part of git-blame output that | |
is repeated meta information per line (such as commit id, | |
author name, date and timezone). Defaults to cyan. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.branch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to enable/disable color in the output of | |
<a href="git-branch.html">git-branch(1)</a>. May be set to <code>always</code>, | |
<code>false</code> (or <code>never</code>) or <code>auto</code> (or <code>true</code>), in which case colors are used | |
only when the output is to a terminal. If unset, then the | |
value of <code>color.ui</code> is used (<code>auto</code> by default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.branch.<slot> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color for branch coloration. <code><slot></code> is one of | |
<code>current</code> (the current branch), <code>local</code> (a local branch), | |
<code>remote</code> (a remote-tracking branch in refs/remotes/), | |
<code>upstream</code> (upstream tracking branch), <code>plain</code> (other | |
refs). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.diff | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether to use ANSI escape sequences to add color to patches. | |
If this is set to <code>always</code>, <a href="git-diff.html">git-diff(1)</a>, | |
<a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a>, and <a href="git-show.html">git-show(1)</a> will use color | |
for all patches. If it is set to <code>true</code> or <code>auto</code>, those | |
commands will only use color when output is to the terminal. | |
If unset, then the value of <code>color.ui</code> is used (<code>auto</code> by | |
default). | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This does not affect <a href="git-format-patch.html">git-format-patch(1)</a> or the | |
<em>git-diff-*</em> plumbing commands. Can be overridden on the | |
command line with the <code>--color[=<when>]</code> option.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.diff.<slot> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color for diff colorization. <code><slot></code> specifies | |
which part of the patch to use the specified color, and is one | |
of <code>context</code> (context text - <code>plain</code> is a historical synonym), | |
<code>meta</code> (metainformation), <code>frag</code> | |
(hunk header), <em>func</em> (function in hunk header), <code>old</code> (removed lines), | |
<code>new</code> (added lines), <code>commit</code> (commit headers), <code>whitespace</code> | |
(highlighting whitespace errors), <code>oldMoved</code> (deleted lines), | |
<code>newMoved</code> (added lines), <code>oldMovedDimmed</code>, <code>oldMovedAlternative</code>, | |
<code>oldMovedAlternativeDimmed</code>, <code>newMovedDimmed</code>, <code>newMovedAlternative</code> | |
<code>newMovedAlternativeDimmed</code> (See the <em><mode></em> | |
setting of <em>--color-moved</em> in <a href="git-diff.html">git-diff(1)</a> for details), | |
<code>contextDimmed</code>, <code>oldDimmed</code>, <code>newDimmed</code>, <code>contextBold</code>, | |
<code>oldBold</code>, and <code>newBold</code> (see <a href="git-range-diff.html">git-range-diff(1)</a> for details). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.decorate.<slot> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color for <em>git log --decorate</em> output. <code><slot></code> is one | |
of <code>branch</code>, <code>remoteBranch</code>, <code>tag</code>, <code>stash</code> or <code>HEAD</code> for local | |
branches, remote-tracking branches, tags, stash and HEAD, respectively | |
and <code>grafted</code> for grafted commits. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.grep | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to <code>always</code>, always highlight matches. When <code>false</code> (or | |
<code>never</code>), never. When set to <code>true</code> or <code>auto</code>, use color only | |
when the output is written to the terminal. If unset, then the | |
value of <code>color.ui</code> is used (<code>auto</code> by default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.grep.<slot> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color for grep colorization. <code><slot></code> specifies which | |
part of the line to use the specified color, and is one of | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>context</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
non-matching text in context lines (when using <code>-A</code>, <code>-B</code>, or <code>-C</code>) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>filename</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
filename prefix (when not using <code>-h</code>) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>function</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
function name lines (when using <code>-p</code>) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>lineNumber</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
line number prefix (when using <code>-n</code>) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>column</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
column number prefix (when using <code>--column</code>) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>match</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
matching text (same as setting <code>matchContext</code> and <code>matchSelected</code>) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>matchContext</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
matching text in context lines | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>matchSelected</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
matching text in selected lines | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>selected</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
non-matching text in selected lines | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>separator</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
separators between fields on a line (<code>:</code>, <code>-</code>, and <code>=</code>) | |
and between hunks (<code>--</code>) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.interactive | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to <code>always</code>, always use colors for interactive prompts | |
and displays (such as those used by "git-add --interactive" and | |
"git-clean --interactive"). When false (or <code>never</code>), never. | |
When set to <code>true</code> or <code>auto</code>, use colors only when the output is | |
to the terminal. If unset, then the value of <code>color.ui</code> is | |
used (<code>auto</code> by default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.interactive.<slot> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color for <em>git add --interactive</em> and <em>git clean | |
--interactive</em> output. <code><slot></code> may be <code>prompt</code>, <code>header</code>, <code>help</code> | |
or <code>error</code>, for four distinct types of normal output from | |
interactive commands. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.pager | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to specify whether <code>auto</code> color modes should colorize | |
output going to the pager. Defaults to true; set this to false | |
if your pager does not understand ANSI color codes. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.push | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to enable/disable color in push errors. May be set to | |
<code>always</code>, <code>false</code> (or <code>never</code>) or <code>auto</code> (or <code>true</code>), in which | |
case colors are used only when the error output goes to a terminal. | |
If unset, then the value of <code>color.ui</code> is used (<code>auto</code> by default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.push.error | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color for push errors. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.remote | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set, keywords at the start of the line are highlighted. The | |
keywords are "error", "warning", "hint" and "success", and are | |
matched case-insensitively. May be set to <code>always</code>, <code>false</code> (or | |
<code>never</code>) or <code>auto</code> (or <code>true</code>). If unset, then the value of | |
<code>color.ui</code> is used (<code>auto</code> by default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.remote.<slot> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color for each remote keyword. <code><slot></code> may be | |
<code>hint</code>, <code>warning</code>, <code>success</code> or <code>error</code> which match the | |
corresponding keyword. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.showBranch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to enable/disable color in the output of | |
<a href="git-show-branch.html">git-show-branch(1)</a>. May be set to <code>always</code>, | |
<code>false</code> (or <code>never</code>) or <code>auto</code> (or <code>true</code>), in which case colors are used | |
only when the output is to a terminal. If unset, then the | |
value of <code>color.ui</code> is used (<code>auto</code> by default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.status | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to enable/disable color in the output of | |
<a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a>. May be set to <code>always</code>, | |
<code>false</code> (or <code>never</code>) or <code>auto</code> (or <code>true</code>), in which case colors are used | |
only when the output is to a terminal. If unset, then the | |
value of <code>color.ui</code> is used (<code>auto</code> by default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.status.<slot> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color for status colorization. <code><slot></code> is | |
one of <code>header</code> (the header text of the status message), | |
<code>added</code> or <code>updated</code> (files which are added but not committed), | |
<code>changed</code> (files which are changed but not added in the index), | |
<code>untracked</code> (files which are not tracked by Git), | |
<code>branch</code> (the current branch), | |
<code>nobranch</code> (the color the <em>no branch</em> warning is shown in, defaulting | |
to red), | |
<code>localBranch</code> or <code>remoteBranch</code> (the local and remote branch names, | |
respectively, when branch and tracking information is displayed in the | |
status short-format), or | |
<code>unmerged</code> (files which have unmerged changes). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.transport | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to enable/disable color when pushes are rejected. May be | |
set to <code>always</code>, <code>false</code> (or <code>never</code>) or <code>auto</code> (or <code>true</code>), in which | |
case colors are used only when the error output goes to a terminal. | |
If unset, then the value of <code>color.ui</code> is used (<code>auto</code> by default). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.transport.rejected | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use customized color when a push was rejected. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
color.ui | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This variable determines the default value for variables such | |
as <code>color.diff</code> and <code>color.grep</code> that control the use of color | |
per command family. Its scope will expand as more commands learn | |
configuration to set a default for the <code>--color</code> option. Set it | |
to <code>false</code> or <code>never</code> if you prefer Git commands not to use | |
color unless enabled explicitly with some other configuration | |
or the <code>--color</code> option. Set it to <code>always</code> if you want all | |
output not intended for machine consumption to use color, to | |
<code>true</code> or <code>auto</code> (this is the default since Git 1.8.4) if you | |
want such output to use color when written to the terminal. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
column.ui | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify whether supported commands should output in columns. | |
This variable consists of a list of tokens separated by spaces | |
or commas: | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>These options control when the feature should be enabled | |
(defaults to <em>never</em>):</p></div> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>always</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
always show in columns | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>never</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
never show in columns | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>auto</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
show in columns if the output is to the terminal | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>These options control layout (defaults to <em>column</em>). Setting any | |
of these implies <em>always</em> if none of <em>always</em>, <em>never</em>, or <em>auto</em> are | |
specified.</p></div> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>column</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
fill columns before rows | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>row</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
fill rows before columns | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>plain</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
show in one column | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Finally, these options can be combined with a layout option (defaults | |
to <em>nodense</em>):</p></div> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>dense</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
make unequal size columns to utilize more space | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>nodense</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
make equal size columns | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
column.branch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify whether to output branch listing in <code>git branch</code> in columns. | |
See <code>column.ui</code> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
column.clean | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the layout when list items in <code>git clean -i</code>, which always | |
shows files and directories in columns. See <code>column.ui</code> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
column.status | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify whether to output untracked files in <code>git status</code> in columns. | |
See <code>column.ui</code> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
column.tag | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify whether to output tag listing in <code>git tag</code> in columns. | |
See <code>column.ui</code> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
commit.cleanup | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This setting overrides the default of the <code>--cleanup</code> option in | |
<code>git commit</code>. See <a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a> for details. Changing the | |
default can be useful when you always want to keep lines that begin | |
with comment character <code>#</code> in your log message, in which case you | |
would do <code>git config commit.cleanup whitespace</code> (note that you will | |
have to remove the help lines that begin with <code>#</code> in the commit log | |
template yourself, if you do this). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
commit.gpgSign | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to specify whether all commits should be GPG signed. | |
Use of this option when doing operations such as rebase can | |
result in a large number of commits being signed. It may be | |
convenient to use an agent to avoid typing your GPG passphrase | |
several times. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
commit.status | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to enable/disable inclusion of status information in the | |
commit message template when using an editor to prepare the commit | |
message. Defaults to true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
commit.template | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the pathname of a file to use as the template for | |
new commit messages. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
commit.verbose | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean or int to specify the level of verbose with <code>git commit</code>. | |
See <a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
commitGraph.generationVersion | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the type of generation number version to use when writing | |
or reading the commit-graph file. If version 1 is specified, then | |
the corrected commit dates will not be written or read. Defaults to | |
2. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
commitGraph.maxNewFilters | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the default value for the <code>--max-new-filters</code> option of <code>git | |
commit-graph write</code> (c.f., <a href="git-commit-graph.html">git-commit-graph(1)</a>). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
commitGraph.readChangedPaths | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, then git will use the changed-path Bloom filters in the | |
commit-graph file (if it exists, and they are present). Defaults to | |
true. See <a href="git-commit-graph.html">git-commit-graph(1)</a> for more information. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
credential.helper | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify an external helper to be called when a username or | |
password credential is needed; the helper may consult external | |
storage to avoid prompting the user for the credentials. This is | |
normally the name of a credential helper with possible | |
arguments, but may also be an absolute path with arguments or, if | |
preceded by <code>!</code>, shell commands. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that multiple helpers may be defined. See <a href="gitcredentials.html">gitcredentials(7)</a> | |
for details and examples.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
credential.useHttpPath | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When acquiring credentials, consider the "path" component of an http | |
or https URL to be important. Defaults to false. See | |
<a href="gitcredentials.html">gitcredentials(7)</a> for more information. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
credential.username | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If no username is set for a network authentication, use this username | |
by default. See credential.<context>.* below, and | |
<a href="gitcredentials.html">gitcredentials(7)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
credential.<url>.* | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Any of the credential.* options above can be applied selectively to | |
some credentials. For example "credential.https://example.com.username" | |
would set the default username only for https connections to | |
example.com. See <a href="gitcredentials.html">gitcredentials(7)</a> for details on how URLs are | |
matched. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
credentialCache.ignoreSIGHUP | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Tell git-credential-cache—daemon to ignore SIGHUP, instead of quitting. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
credentialStore.lockTimeoutMS | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The length of time, in milliseconds, for git-credential-store to retry | |
when trying to lock the credentials file. Value 0 means not to retry at | |
all; -1 means to try indefinitely. Default is 1000 (i.e., retry for | |
1s). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
completion.commands | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This is only used by git-completion.bash to add or remove | |
commands from the list of completed commands. Normally only | |
porcelain commands and a few select others are completed. You | |
can add more commands, separated by space, in this | |
variable. Prefixing the command with <em>-</em> will remove it from | |
the existing list. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.autoRefreshIndex | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When using <em>git diff</em> to compare with work tree | |
files, do not consider stat-only change as changed. | |
Instead, silently run <code>git update-index --refresh</code> to | |
update the cached stat information for paths whose | |
contents in the work tree match the contents in the | |
index. This option defaults to true. Note that this | |
affects only <em>git diff</em> Porcelain, and not lower level | |
<em>diff</em> commands such as <em>git diff-files</em>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.dirstat | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A comma separated list of <code>--dirstat</code> parameters specifying the | |
default behavior of the <code>--dirstat</code> option to <a href="git-diff.html">git-diff(1)</a> | |
and friends. The defaults can be overridden on the command line | |
(using <code>--dirstat=<param1,param2,...></code>). The fallback defaults | |
(when not changed by <code>diff.dirstat</code>) are <code>changes,noncumulative,3</code>. | |
The following parameters are available: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>changes</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Compute the dirstat numbers by counting the lines that have been | |
removed from the source, or added to the destination. This ignores | |
the amount of pure code movements within a file. In other words, | |
rearranging lines in a file is not counted as much as other changes. | |
This is the default behavior when no parameter is given. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>lines</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Compute the dirstat numbers by doing the regular line-based diff | |
analysis, and summing the removed/added line counts. (For binary | |
files, count 64-byte chunks instead, since binary files have no | |
natural concept of lines). This is a more expensive <code>--dirstat</code> | |
behavior than the <code>changes</code> behavior, but it does count rearranged | |
lines within a file as much as other changes. The resulting output | |
is consistent with what you get from the other <code>--*stat</code> options. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>files</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Compute the dirstat numbers by counting the number of files changed. | |
Each changed file counts equally in the dirstat analysis. This is | |
the computationally cheapest <code>--dirstat</code> behavior, since it does | |
not have to look at the file contents at all. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>cumulative</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Count changes in a child directory for the parent directory as well. | |
Note that when using <code>cumulative</code>, the sum of the percentages | |
reported may exceed 100%. The default (non-cumulative) behavior can | |
be specified with the <code>noncumulative</code> parameter. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<limit> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
An integer parameter specifies a cut-off percent (3% by default). | |
Directories contributing less than this percentage of the changes | |
are not shown in the output. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Example: The following will count changed files, while ignoring | |
directories with less than 10% of the total amount of changed files, | |
and accumulating child directory counts in the parent directories: | |
<code>files,10,cumulative</code>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.statGraphWidth | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Limit the width of the graph part in --stat output. If set, applies | |
to all commands generating --stat output except format-patch. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.context | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Generate diffs with <n> lines of context instead of the default | |
of 3. This value is overridden by the -U option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.interHunkContext | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Show the context between diff hunks, up to the specified number | |
of lines, thereby fusing the hunks that are close to each other. | |
This value serves as the default for the <code>--inter-hunk-context</code> | |
command line option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.external | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If this config variable is set, diff generation is not | |
performed using the internal diff machinery, but using the | |
given command. Can be overridden with the ‘GIT_EXTERNAL_DIFF’ | |
environment variable. The command is called with parameters | |
as described under "git Diffs" in <a href="git.html">git(1)</a>. Note: if | |
you want to use an external diff program only on a subset of | |
your files, you might want to use <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> instead. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.ignoreSubmodules | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Sets the default value of --ignore-submodules. Note that this | |
affects only <em>git diff</em> Porcelain, and not lower level <em>diff</em> | |
commands such as <em>git diff-files</em>. <em>git checkout</em> | |
and <em>git switch</em> also honor | |
this setting when reporting uncommitted changes. Setting it to | |
<em>all</em> disables the submodule summary normally shown by <em>git commit</em> | |
and <em>git status</em> when <code>status.submoduleSummary</code> is set unless it is | |
overridden by using the --ignore-submodules command-line option. | |
The <em>git submodule</em> commands are not affected by this setting. | |
By default this is set to untracked so that any untracked | |
submodules are ignored. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.mnemonicPrefix | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set, <em>git diff</em> uses a prefix pair that is different from the | |
standard "a/" and "b/" depending on what is being compared. When | |
this configuration is in effect, reverse diff output also swaps | |
the order of the prefixes: | |
</p> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>git diff</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
compares the (i)ndex and the (w)ork tree; | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>git diff HEAD</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
compares a (c)ommit and the (w)ork tree; | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>git diff --cached</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
compares a (c)ommit and the (i)ndex; | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>git diff HEAD:file1 file2</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
compares an (o)bject and a (w)ork tree entity; | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>git diff --no-index a b</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
compares two non-git things (1) and (2). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.noprefix | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set, <em>git diff</em> does not show any source or destination prefix. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.relative | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to <em>true</em>, <em>git diff</em> does not show changes outside of the directory | |
and show pathnames relative to the current directory. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.orderFile | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
File indicating how to order files within a diff. | |
See the <em>-O</em> option to <a href="git-diff.html">git-diff(1)</a> for details. | |
If <code>diff.orderFile</code> is a relative pathname, it is treated as | |
relative to the top of the working tree. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.renameLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The number of files to consider in the exhaustive portion of | |
copy/rename detection; equivalent to the <em>git diff</em> option | |
<code>-l</code>. If not set, the default value is currently 1000. This | |
setting has no effect if rename detection is turned off. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.renames | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether and how Git detects renames. If set to "false", | |
rename detection is disabled. If set to "true", basic rename | |
detection is enabled. If set to "copies" or "copy", Git will | |
detect copies, as well. Defaults to true. Note that this | |
affects only <em>git diff</em> Porcelain like <a href="git-diff.html">git-diff(1)</a> and | |
<a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a>, and not lower level commands such as | |
<a href="git-diff-files.html">git-diff-files(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.suppressBlankEmpty | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to inhibit the standard behavior of printing a space | |
before each empty output line. Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.submodule | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the format in which differences in submodules are | |
shown. The "short" format just shows the names of the commits | |
at the beginning and end of the range. The "log" format lists | |
the commits in the range like <a href="git-submodule.html">git-submodule(1)</a> <code>summary</code> | |
does. The "diff" format shows an inline diff of the changed | |
contents of the submodule. Defaults to "short". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.wordRegex | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A POSIX Extended Regular Expression used to determine what is a "word" | |
when performing word-by-word difference calculations. Character | |
sequences that match the regular expression are "words", all other | |
characters are <strong>ignorable</strong> whitespace. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.<driver>.command | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The custom diff driver command. See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> | |
for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.<driver>.xfuncname | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The regular expression that the diff driver should use to | |
recognize the hunk header. A built-in pattern may also be used. | |
See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.<driver>.binary | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set this option to true to make the diff driver treat files as | |
binary. See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.<driver>.textconv | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The command that the diff driver should call to generate the | |
text-converted version of a file. The result of the | |
conversion is used to generate a human-readable diff. See | |
<a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.<driver>.wordRegex | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The regular expression that the diff driver should use to | |
split words in a line. See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for | |
details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.<driver>.cachetextconv | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set this option to true to make the diff driver cache the text | |
conversion outputs. See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.tool | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Controls which diff tool is used by <a href="git-difftool.html">git-difftool(1)</a>. | |
This variable overrides the value configured in <code>merge.tool</code>. | |
The list below shows the valid built-in values. | |
Any other value is treated as a custom diff tool and requires | |
that a corresponding difftool.<tool>.cmd variable is defined. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.guitool | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Controls which diff tool is used by <a href="git-difftool.html">git-difftool(1)</a> when | |
the -g/--gui flag is specified. This variable overrides the value | |
configured in <code>merge.guitool</code>. The list below shows the valid | |
built-in values. Any other value is treated as a custom diff tool | |
and requires that a corresponding difftool.<guitool>.cmd variable | |
is defined. | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
araxis | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
bc | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
bc3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
bc4 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
codecompare | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
deltawalker | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
diffmerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
diffuse | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
ecmerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
emerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
examdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
guiffy | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
gvimdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
gvimdiff1 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
gvimdiff2 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
gvimdiff3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
kdiff3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
kompare | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
meld | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
nvimdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
nvimdiff1 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
nvimdiff2 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
nvimdiff3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
opendiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
p4merge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
smerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
tkdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
vimdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
vimdiff1 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
vimdiff2 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
vimdiff3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
winmerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
xxdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.indentHeuristic | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set this option to <code>false</code> to disable the default heuristics | |
that shift diff hunk boundaries to make patches easier to read. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.algorithm | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Choose a diff algorithm. The variants are as follows: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>default</code>, <code>myers</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The basic greedy diff algorithm. Currently, this is the default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>minimal</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Spend extra time to make sure the smallest possible diff is | |
produced. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>patience</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use "patience diff" algorithm when generating patches. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
<code>histogram</code> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This algorithm extends the patience algorithm to "support | |
low-occurrence common elements". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.wsErrorHighlight | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Highlight whitespace errors in the <code>context</code>, <code>old</code> or <code>new</code> | |
lines of the diff. Multiple values are separated by comma, | |
<code>none</code> resets previous values, <code>default</code> reset the list to | |
<code>new</code> and <code>all</code> is a shorthand for <code>old,new,context</code>. The | |
whitespace errors are colored with <code>color.diff.whitespace</code>. | |
The command line option <code>--ws-error-highlight=<kind></code> | |
overrides this setting. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.colorMoved | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to either a valid <code><mode></code> or a true value, moved lines | |
in a diff are colored differently, for details of valid modes | |
see <em>--color-moved</em> in <a href="git-diff.html">git-diff(1)</a>. If simply set to | |
true the default color mode will be used. When set to false, | |
moved lines are not colored. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
diff.colorMovedWS | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When moved lines are colored using e.g. the <code>diff.colorMoved</code> setting, | |
this option controls the <code><mode></code> how spaces are treated | |
for details of valid modes see <em>--color-moved-ws</em> in <a href="git-diff.html">git-diff(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
difftool.<tool>.path | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Override the path for the given tool. This is useful in case | |
your tool is not in the PATH. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
difftool.<tool>.cmd | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the command to invoke the specified diff tool. | |
The specified command is evaluated in shell with the following | |
variables available: <em>LOCAL</em> is set to the name of the temporary | |
file containing the contents of the diff pre-image and <em>REMOTE</em> | |
is set to the name of the temporary file containing the contents | |
of the diff post-image. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
difftool.prompt | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Prompt before each invocation of the diff tool. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
extensions.objectFormat | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the hash algorithm to use. The acceptable values are <code>sha1</code> and | |
<code>sha256</code>. If not specified, <code>sha1</code> is assumed. It is an error to specify | |
this key unless <code>core.repositoryFormatVersion</code> is 1. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that this setting should only be set by <a href="git-init.html">git-init(1)</a> or | |
<a href="git-clone.html">git-clone(1)</a>. Trying to change it after initialization will not | |
work and will produce hard-to-diagnose issues.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fastimport.unpackLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If the number of objects imported by <a href="git-fast-import.html">git-fast-import(1)</a> | |
is below this limit, then the objects will be unpacked into | |
loose object files. However if the number of imported objects | |
equals or exceeds this limit then the pack will be stored as a | |
pack. Storing the pack from a fast-import can make the import | |
operation complete faster, especially on slow filesystems. If | |
not set, the value of <code>transfer.unpackLimit</code> is used instead. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
feature.* | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The config settings that start with <code>feature.</code> modify the defaults of | |
a group of other config settings. These groups are created by the Git | |
developer community as recommended defaults and are subject to change. | |
In particular, new config options may be added with different defaults. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
feature.experimental | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Enable config options that are new to Git, and are being considered for | |
future defaults. Config settings included here may be added or removed | |
with each release, including minor version updates. These settings may | |
have unintended interactions since they are so new. Please enable this | |
setting if you are interested in providing feedback on experimental | |
features. The new default values are: | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>fetch.negotiationAlgorithm=skipping</code> may improve fetch negotiation times by | |
skipping more commits at a time, reducing the number of round trips. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
feature.manyFiles | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Enable config options that optimize for repos with many files in the | |
working directory. With many files, commands such as <code>git status</code> and | |
<code>git checkout</code> may be slow and these new defaults improve performance: | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>index.version=4</code> enables path-prefix compression in the index. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>core.untrackedCache=true</code> enables the untracked cache. This setting assumes | |
that mtime is working on your machine. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.recurseSubmodules | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This option controls whether <code>git fetch</code> (and the underlying fetch | |
in <code>git pull</code>) will recursively fetch into populated submodules. | |
This option can be set either to a boolean value or to <em>on-demand</em>. | |
Setting it to a boolean changes the behavior of fetch and pull to | |
recurse unconditionally into submodules when set to true or to not | |
recurse at all when set to false. When set to <em>on-demand</em>, fetch and | |
pull will only recurse into a populated submodule when its | |
superproject retrieves a commit that updates the submodule’s | |
reference. | |
Defaults to <em>on-demand</em>, or to the value of <em>submodule.recurse</em> if set. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.fsckObjects | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If it is set to true, git-fetch-pack will check all fetched | |
objects. See <code>transfer.fsckObjects</code> for what’s | |
checked. Defaults to false. If not set, the value of | |
<code>transfer.fsckObjects</code> is used instead. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.fsck.<msg-id> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Acts like <code>fsck.<msg-id></code>, but is used by | |
<a href="git-fetch-pack.html">git-fetch-pack(1)</a> instead of <a href="git-fsck.html">git-fsck(1)</a>. See | |
the <code>fsck.<msg-id></code> documentation for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.fsck.skipList | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Acts like <code>fsck.skipList</code>, but is used by | |
<a href="git-fetch-pack.html">git-fetch-pack(1)</a> instead of <a href="git-fsck.html">git-fsck(1)</a>. See | |
the <code>fsck.skipList</code> documentation for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.unpackLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If the number of objects fetched over the Git native | |
transfer is below this | |
limit, then the objects will be unpacked into loose object | |
files. However if the number of received objects equals or | |
exceeds this limit then the received pack will be stored as | |
a pack, after adding any missing delta bases. Storing the | |
pack from a push can make the push operation complete faster, | |
especially on slow filesystems. If not set, the value of | |
<code>transfer.unpackLimit</code> is used instead. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.prune | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, fetch will automatically behave as if the <code>--prune</code> | |
option was given on the command line. See also <code>remote.<name>.prune</code> | |
and the PRUNING section of <a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.pruneTags | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, fetch will automatically behave as if the | |
<code>refs/tags/*:refs/tags/*</code> refspec was provided when pruning, | |
if not set already. This allows for setting both this option | |
and <code>fetch.prune</code> to maintain a 1=1 mapping to upstream | |
refs. See also <code>remote.<name>.pruneTags</code> and the PRUNING | |
section of <a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.output | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Control how ref update status is printed. Valid values are | |
<code>full</code> and <code>compact</code>. Default value is <code>full</code>. See section | |
OUTPUT in <a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a> for detail. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.negotiationAlgorithm | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Control how information about the commits in the local repository is | |
sent when negotiating the contents of the packfile to be sent by the | |
server. Set to "skipping" to use an algorithm that skips commits in an | |
effort to converge faster, but may result in a larger-than-necessary | |
packfile; or set to "noop" to not send any information at all, which | |
will almost certainly result in a larger-than-necessary packfile, but | |
will skip the negotiation step. | |
The default is "default" which instructs Git to use the default algorithm | |
that never skips commits (unless the server has acknowledged it or one | |
of its descendants). If <code>feature.experimental</code> is enabled, then this | |
setting defaults to "skipping". | |
Unknown values will cause <em>git fetch</em> to error out. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also the <code>--negotiate-only</code> and <code>--negotiation-tip</code> options to | |
<a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.showForcedUpdates | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set to false to enable <code>--no-show-forced-updates</code> in | |
<a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a> and <a href="git-pull.html">git-pull(1)</a> commands. | |
Defaults to true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.parallel | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the maximal number of fetch operations to be run in parallel | |
at a time (submodules, or remotes when the <code>--multiple</code> option of | |
<a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a> is in effect). | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>A value of 0 will give some reasonable default. If unset, it defaults to 1.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For submodules, this setting can be overridden using the <code>submodule.fetchJobs</code> | |
config setting.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fetch.writeCommitGraph | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set to true to write a commit-graph after every <code>git fetch</code> command | |
that downloads a pack-file from a remote. Using the <code>--split</code> option, | |
most executions will create a very small commit-graph file on top of | |
the existing commit-graph file(s). Occasionally, these files will | |
merge and the write may take longer. Having an updated commit-graph | |
file helps performance of many Git commands, including <code>git merge-base</code>, | |
<code>git push -f</code>, and <code>git log --graph</code>. Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.attach | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Enable multipart/mixed attachments as the default for | |
<em>format-patch</em>. The value can also be a double quoted string | |
which will enable attachments as the default and set the | |
value as the boundary. See the --attach option in | |
<a href="git-format-patch.html">git-format-patch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.from | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Provides the default value for the <code>--from</code> option to format-patch. | |
Accepts a boolean value, or a name and email address. If false, | |
format-patch defaults to <code>--no-from</code>, using commit authors directly in | |
the "From:" field of patch mails. If true, format-patch defaults to | |
<code>--from</code>, using your committer identity in the "From:" field of patch | |
mails and including a "From:" field in the body of the patch mail if | |
different. If set to a non-boolean value, format-patch uses that | |
value instead of your committer identity. Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.numbered | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean which can enable or disable sequence numbers in patch | |
subjects. It defaults to "auto" which enables it only if there | |
is more than one patch. It can be enabled or disabled for all | |
messages by setting it to "true" or "false". See --numbered | |
option in <a href="git-format-patch.html">git-format-patch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.headers | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Additional email headers to include in a patch to be submitted | |
by mail. See <a href="git-format-patch.html">git-format-patch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.to | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.cc | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Additional recipients to include in a patch to be submitted | |
by mail. See the --to and --cc options in | |
<a href="git-format-patch.html">git-format-patch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.subjectPrefix | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default for format-patch is to output files with the <em>[PATCH]</em> | |
subject prefix. Use this variable to change that prefix. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.coverFromDescription | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default mode for format-patch to determine which parts of | |
the cover letter will be populated using the branch’s | |
description. See the <code>--cover-from-description</code> option in | |
<a href="git-format-patch.html">git-format-patch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.signature | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default for format-patch is to output a signature containing | |
the Git version number. Use this variable to change that default. | |
Set this variable to the empty string ("") to suppress | |
signature generation. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.signatureFile | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Works just like format.signature except the contents of the | |
file specified by this variable will be used as the signature. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.suffix | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default for format-patch is to output files with the suffix | |
<code>.patch</code>. Use this variable to change that suffix (make sure to | |
include the dot if you want it). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.encodeEmailHeaders | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Encode email headers that have non-ASCII characters with | |
"Q-encoding" (described in RFC 2047) for email transmission. | |
Defaults to true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.pretty | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default pretty format for log/show/whatchanged command, | |
See <a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a>, <a href="git-show.html">git-show(1)</a>, | |
<a href="git-whatchanged.html">git-whatchanged(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.thread | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default threading style for <em>git format-patch</em>. Can be | |
a boolean value, or <code>shallow</code> or <code>deep</code>. <code>shallow</code> threading | |
makes every mail a reply to the head of the series, | |
where the head is chosen from the cover letter, the | |
<code>--in-reply-to</code>, and the first patch mail, in this order. | |
<code>deep</code> threading makes every mail a reply to the previous one. | |
A true boolean value is the same as <code>shallow</code>, and a false | |
value disables threading. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.signOff | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean value which lets you enable the <code>-s/--signoff</code> option of | |
format-patch by default. <strong>Note:</strong> Adding the <code>Signed-off-by</code> trailer to a | |
patch should be a conscious act and means that you certify you have | |
the rights to submit this work under the same open source license. | |
Please see the <em>SubmittingPatches</em> document for further discussion. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.coverLetter | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean that controls whether to generate a cover-letter when | |
format-patch is invoked, but in addition can be set to "auto", to | |
generate a cover-letter only when there’s more than one patch. | |
Default is false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.outputDirectory | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set a custom directory to store the resulting files instead of the | |
current working directory. All directory components will be created. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.filenameMaxLength | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The maximum length of the output filenames generated by the | |
<code>format-patch</code> command; defaults to 64. Can be overridden | |
by the <code>--filename-max-length=<n></code> command line option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.useAutoBase | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean value which lets you enable the <code>--base=auto</code> option of | |
format-patch by default. Can also be set to "whenAble" to allow | |
enabling <code>--base=auto</code> if a suitable base is available, but to skip | |
adding base info otherwise without the format dying. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
format.notes | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Provides the default value for the <code>--notes</code> option to | |
format-patch. Accepts a boolean value, or a ref which specifies | |
where to get notes. If false, format-patch defaults to | |
<code>--no-notes</code>. If true, format-patch defaults to <code>--notes</code>. If | |
set to a non-boolean value, format-patch defaults to | |
<code>--notes=<ref></code>, where <code>ref</code> is the non-boolean value. Defaults | |
to false. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If one wishes to use the ref <code>ref/notes/true</code>, please use that literal | |
instead.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This configuration can be specified multiple times in order to allow | |
multiple notes refs to be included. In that case, it will behave | |
similarly to multiple <code>--[no-]notes[=]</code> options passed in. That is, a | |
value of <code>true</code> will show the default notes, a value of <code><ref></code> will | |
also show notes from that notes ref and a value of <code>false</code> will negate | |
previous configurations and not show notes.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example,</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>[format] | |
notes = true | |
notes = foo | |
notes = false | |
notes = bar</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>will only show notes from <code>refs/notes/bar</code>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
filter.<driver>.clean | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The command which is used to convert the content of a worktree | |
file to a blob upon checkin. See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for | |
details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
filter.<driver>.smudge | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The command which is used to convert the content of a blob | |
object to a worktree file upon checkout. See | |
<a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fsck.<msg-id> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
During fsck git may find issues with legacy data which | |
wouldn’t be generated by current versions of git, and which | |
wouldn’t be sent over the wire if <code>transfer.fsckObjects</code> was | |
set. This feature is intended to support working with legacy | |
repositories containing such data. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Setting <code>fsck.<msg-id></code> will be picked up by <a href="git-fsck.html">git-fsck(1)</a>, but | |
to accept pushes of such data set <code>receive.fsck.<msg-id></code> instead, or | |
to clone or fetch it set <code>fetch.fsck.<msg-id></code>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The rest of the documentation discusses <code>fsck.*</code> for brevity, but the | |
same applies for the corresponding <code>receive.fsck.*</code> and | |
<code>fetch.<msg-id>.*</code>. variables.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Unlike variables like <code>color.ui</code> and <code>core.editor</code> the | |
<code>receive.fsck.<msg-id></code> and <code>fetch.fsck.<msg-id></code> variables will not | |
fall back on the <code>fsck.<msg-id></code> configuration if they aren’t set. To | |
uniformly configure the same fsck settings in different circumstances | |
all three of them they must all set to the same values.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When <code>fsck.<msg-id></code> is set, errors can be switched to warnings and | |
vice versa by configuring the <code>fsck.<msg-id></code> setting where the | |
<code><msg-id></code> is the fsck message ID and the value is one of <code>error</code>, | |
<code>warn</code> or <code>ignore</code>. For convenience, fsck prefixes the error/warning | |
with the message ID, e.g. "missingEmail: invalid author/committer | |
line - missing email" means that setting <code>fsck.missingEmail = ignore</code> | |
will hide that issue.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>In general, it is better to enumerate existing objects with problems | |
with <code>fsck.skipList</code>, instead of listing the kind of breakages these | |
problematic objects share to be ignored, as doing the latter will | |
allow new instances of the same breakages go unnoticed.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Setting an unknown <code>fsck.<msg-id></code> value will cause fsck to die, but | |
doing the same for <code>receive.fsck.<msg-id></code> and <code>fetch.fsck.<msg-id></code> | |
will only cause git to warn.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
fsck.skipList | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The path to a list of object names (i.e. one unabbreviated SHA-1 per | |
line) that are known to be broken in a non-fatal way and should | |
be ignored. On versions of Git 2.20 and later comments (<em>#</em>), empty | |
lines, and any leading and trailing whitespace is ignored. Everything | |
but a SHA-1 per line will error out on older versions. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This feature is useful when an established project should be accepted | |
despite early commits containing errors that can be safely ignored | |
such as invalid committer email addresses. Note: corrupt objects | |
cannot be skipped with this setting.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Like <code>fsck.<msg-id></code> this variable has corresponding | |
<code>receive.fsck.skipList</code> and <code>fetch.fsck.skipList</code> variants.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Unlike variables like <code>color.ui</code> and <code>core.editor</code> the | |
<code>receive.fsck.skipList</code> and <code>fetch.fsck.skipList</code> variables will not | |
fall back on the <code>fsck.skipList</code> configuration if they aren’t set. To | |
uniformly configure the same fsck settings in different circumstances | |
all three of them they must all set to the same values.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Older versions of Git (before 2.20) documented that the object names | |
list should be sorted. This was never a requirement, the object names | |
could appear in any order, but when reading the list we tracked whether | |
the list was sorted for the purposes of an internal binary search | |
implementation, which could save itself some work with an already sorted | |
list. Unless you had a humongous list there was no reason to go out of | |
your way to pre-sort the list. After Git version 2.20 a hash implementation | |
is used instead, so there’s now no reason to pre-sort the list.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.aggressiveDepth | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The depth parameter used in the delta compression | |
algorithm used by <em>git gc --aggressive</em>. This defaults | |
to 50, which is the default for the <code>--depth</code> option when | |
<code>--aggressive</code> isn’t in use. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See the documentation for the <code>--depth</code> option in | |
<a href="git-repack.html">git-repack(1)</a> for more details.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.aggressiveWindow | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The window size parameter used in the delta compression | |
algorithm used by <em>git gc --aggressive</em>. This defaults | |
to 250, which is a much more aggressive window size than | |
the default <code>--window</code> of 10. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See the documentation for the <code>--window</code> option in | |
<a href="git-repack.html">git-repack(1)</a> for more details.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.auto | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When there are approximately more than this many loose | |
objects in the repository, <code>git gc --auto</code> will pack them. | |
Some Porcelain commands use this command to perform a | |
light-weight garbage collection from time to time. The | |
default value is 6700. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Setting this to 0 disables not only automatic packing based on the | |
number of loose objects, but any other heuristic <code>git gc --auto</code> will | |
otherwise use to determine if there’s work to do, such as | |
<code>gc.autoPackLimit</code>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.autoPackLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When there are more than this many packs that are not | |
marked with <code>*.keep</code> file in the repository, <code>git gc | |
--auto</code> consolidates them into one larger pack. The | |
default value is 50. Setting this to 0 disables it. | |
Setting <code>gc.auto</code> to 0 will also disable this. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See the <code>gc.bigPackThreshold</code> configuration variable below. When in | |
use, it’ll affect how the auto pack limit works.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.autoDetach | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Make <code>git gc --auto</code> return immediately and run in background | |
if the system supports it. Default is true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.bigPackThreshold | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If non-zero, all packs larger than this limit are kept when | |
<code>git gc</code> is run. This is very similar to <code>--keep-largest-pack</code> | |
except that all packs that meet the threshold are kept, not | |
just the largest pack. Defaults to zero. Common unit suffixes of | |
<em>k</em>, <em>m</em>, or <em>g</em> are supported. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that if the number of kept packs is more than gc.autoPackLimit, | |
this configuration variable is ignored, all packs except the base pack | |
will be repacked. After this the number of packs should go below | |
gc.autoPackLimit and gc.bigPackThreshold should be respected again.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the amount of memory estimated for <code>git repack</code> to run smoothly is | |
not available and <code>gc.bigPackThreshold</code> is not set, the largest pack | |
will also be excluded (this is the equivalent of running <code>git gc</code> with | |
<code>--keep-largest-pack</code>).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.writeCommitGraph | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, then gc will rewrite the commit-graph file when | |
<a href="git-gc.html">git-gc(1)</a> is run. When using <code>git gc --auto</code> | |
the commit-graph will be updated if housekeeping is | |
required. Default is true. See <a href="git-commit-graph.html">git-commit-graph(1)</a> | |
for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.logExpiry | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If the file gc.log exists, then <code>git gc --auto</code> will print | |
its content and exit with status zero instead of running | |
unless that file is more than <em>gc.logExpiry</em> old. Default is | |
"1.day". See <code>gc.pruneExpire</code> for more ways to specify its | |
value. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.packRefs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Running <code>git pack-refs</code> in a repository renders it | |
unclonable by Git versions prior to 1.5.1.2 over dumb | |
transports such as HTTP. This variable determines whether | |
<em>git gc</em> runs <code>git pack-refs</code>. This can be set to <code>notbare</code> | |
to enable it within all non-bare repos or it can be set to a | |
boolean value. The default is <code>true</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.pruneExpire | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When <em>git gc</em> is run, it will call <em>prune --expire 2.weeks.ago</em>. | |
Override the grace period with this config variable. The value | |
"now" may be used to disable this grace period and always prune | |
unreachable objects immediately, or "never" may be used to | |
suppress pruning. This feature helps prevent corruption when | |
<em>git gc</em> runs concurrently with another process writing to the | |
repository; see the "NOTES" section of <a href="git-gc.html">git-gc(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.worktreePruneExpire | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When <em>git gc</em> is run, it calls | |
<em>git worktree prune --expire 3.months.ago</em>. | |
This config variable can be used to set a different grace | |
period. The value "now" may be used to disable the grace | |
period and prune <code>$GIT_DIR/worktrees</code> immediately, or "never" | |
may be used to suppress pruning. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.reflogExpire | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.<pattern>.reflogExpire | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
<em>git reflog expire</em> removes reflog entries older than | |
this time; defaults to 90 days. The value "now" expires all | |
entries immediately, and "never" suppresses expiration | |
altogether. With "<pattern>" (e.g. | |
"refs/stash") in the middle the setting applies only to | |
the refs that match the <pattern>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.reflogExpireUnreachable | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.<pattern>.reflogExpireUnreachable | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
<em>git reflog expire</em> removes reflog entries older than | |
this time and are not reachable from the current tip; | |
defaults to 30 days. The value "now" expires all entries | |
immediately, and "never" suppresses expiration altogether. | |
With "<pattern>" (e.g. "refs/stash") | |
in the middle, the setting applies only to the refs that | |
match the <pattern>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>These types of entries are generally created as a result of using <code>git | |
commit --amend</code> or <code>git rebase</code> and are the commits prior to the amend | |
or rebase occurring. Since these changes are not part of the current | |
project most users will want to expire them sooner, which is why the | |
default is more aggressive than <code>gc.reflogExpire</code>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.rerereResolved | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Records of conflicted merge you resolved earlier are | |
kept for this many days when <em>git rerere gc</em> is run. | |
You can also use more human-readable "1.month.ago", etc. | |
The default is 60 days. See <a href="git-rerere.html">git-rerere(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gc.rerereUnresolved | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Records of conflicted merge you have not resolved are | |
kept for this many days when <em>git rerere gc</em> is run. | |
You can also use more human-readable "1.month.ago", etc. | |
The default is 15 days. See <a href="git-rerere.html">git-rerere(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitcvs.commitMsgAnnotation | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Append this string to each commit message. Set to empty string | |
to disable this feature. Defaults to "via git-CVS emulator". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitcvs.enabled | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether the CVS server interface is enabled for this repository. | |
See <a href="git-cvsserver.html">git-cvsserver(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitcvs.logFile | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Path to a log file where the CVS server interface well… logs | |
various stuff. See <a href="git-cvsserver.html">git-cvsserver(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitcvs.usecrlfattr | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, the server will look up the end-of-line conversion | |
attributes for files to determine the <code>-k</code> modes to use. If | |
the attributes force Git to treat a file as text, | |
the <code>-k</code> mode will be left blank so CVS clients will | |
treat it as text. If they suppress text conversion, the file | |
will be set with <em>-kb</em> mode, which suppresses any newline munging | |
the client might otherwise do. If the attributes do not allow | |
the file type to be determined, then <code>gitcvs.allBinary</code> is | |
used. See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitcvs.allBinary | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This is used if <code>gitcvs.usecrlfattr</code> does not resolve | |
the correct <em>-kb</em> mode to use. If true, all | |
unresolved files are sent to the client in | |
mode <em>-kb</em>. This causes the client to treat them | |
as binary files, which suppresses any newline munging it | |
otherwise might do. Alternatively, if it is set to "guess", | |
then the contents of the file are examined to decide if | |
it is binary, similar to <code>core.autocrlf</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitcvs.dbName | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Database used by git-cvsserver to cache revision information | |
derived from the Git repository. The exact meaning depends on the | |
used database driver, for SQLite (which is the default driver) this | |
is a filename. Supports variable substitution (see | |
<a href="git-cvsserver.html">git-cvsserver(1)</a> for details). May not contain semicolons (<code>;</code>). | |
Default: <em>%Ggitcvs.%m.sqlite</em> | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitcvs.dbDriver | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Used Perl DBI driver. You can specify any available driver | |
for this here, but it might not work. git-cvsserver is tested | |
with <em>DBD::SQLite</em>, reported to work with <em>DBD::Pg</em>, and | |
reported <strong>not</strong> to work with <em>DBD::mysql</em>. Experimental feature. | |
May not contain double colons (<code>:</code>). Default: <em>SQLite</em>. | |
See <a href="git-cvsserver.html">git-cvsserver(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitcvs.dbUser, gitcvs.dbPass | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Database user and password. Only useful if setting <code>gitcvs.dbDriver</code>, | |
since SQLite has no concept of database users and/or passwords. | |
<em>gitcvs.dbUser</em> supports variable substitution (see | |
<a href="git-cvsserver.html">git-cvsserver(1)</a> for details). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitcvs.dbTableNamePrefix | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Database table name prefix. Prepended to the names of any | |
database tables used, allowing a single database to be used | |
for several repositories. Supports variable substitution (see | |
<a href="git-cvsserver.html">git-cvsserver(1)</a> for details). Any non-alphabetic | |
characters will be replaced with underscores. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>All gitcvs variables except for <code>gitcvs.usecrlfattr</code> and | |
<code>gitcvs.allBinary</code> can also be specified as | |
<em>gitcvs.<access_method>.<varname></em> (where <em>access_method</em> | |
is one of "ext" and "pserver") to make them apply only for the given | |
access method.</p></div> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.category | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.description | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.owner | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.url | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
See <a href="gitweb.html">gitweb(1)</a> for description. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.avatar | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.blame | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.grep | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.highlight | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.patches | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.pickaxe | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.remote_heads | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.showSizes | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gitweb.snapshot | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
See <a href="gitweb.conf.html">gitweb.conf(5)</a> for description. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
grep.lineNumber | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, enable <code>-n</code> option by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
grep.column | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, enable the <code>--column</code> option by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
grep.patternType | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set the default matching behavior. Using a value of <em>basic</em>, <em>extended</em>, | |
<em>fixed</em>, or <em>perl</em> will enable the <code>--basic-regexp</code>, <code>--extended-regexp</code>, | |
<code>--fixed-strings</code>, or <code>--perl-regexp</code> option accordingly, while the | |
value <em>default</em> will return to the default matching behavior. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
grep.extendedRegexp | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, enable <code>--extended-regexp</code> option by default. This | |
option is ignored when the <code>grep.patternType</code> option is set to a value | |
other than <em>default</em>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
grep.threads | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Number of grep worker threads to use. | |
See <code>grep.threads</code> in <a href="git-grep.html">git-grep(1)</a> for more information. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
grep.fallbackToNoIndex | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, fall back to git grep --no-index if git grep | |
is executed outside of a git repository. Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gpg.program | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use this custom program instead of "<code>gpg</code>" found on <code>$PATH</code> when | |
making or verifying a PGP signature. The program must support the | |
same command-line interface as GPG, namely, to verify a detached | |
signature, "<code>gpg --verify $signature - <$file</code>" is run, and the | |
program is expected to signal a good signature by exiting with | |
code 0, and to generate an ASCII-armored detached signature, the | |
standard input of "<code>gpg -bsau $key</code>" is fed with the contents to be | |
signed, and the program is expected to send the result to its | |
standard output. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gpg.format | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies which key format to use when signing with <code>--gpg-sign</code>. | |
Default is "openpgp" and another possible value is "x509". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gpg.<format>.program | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use this to customize the program used for the signing format you | |
chose. (see <code>gpg.program</code> and <code>gpg.format</code>) <code>gpg.program</code> can still | |
be used as a legacy synonym for <code>gpg.openpgp.program</code>. The default | |
value for <code>gpg.x509.program</code> is "gpgsm". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gpg.minTrustLevel | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies a minimum trust level for signature verification. If | |
this option is unset, then signature verification for merge | |
operations require a key with at least <code>marginal</code> trust. Other | |
operations that perform signature verification require a key | |
with at least <code>undefined</code> trust. Setting this option overrides | |
the required trust-level for all operations. Supported values, | |
in increasing order of significance: | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>undefined</code> | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>never</code> | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>marginal</code> | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>fully</code> | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>ultimate</code> | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.commitMsgWidth | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Defines how wide the commit message window is in the | |
<a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a>. "75" is the default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.diffContext | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies how many context lines should be used in calls to diff | |
made by the <a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a>. The default is "5". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.displayUntracked | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Determines if <a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a> shows untracked files | |
in the file list. The default is "true". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.encoding | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the default character encoding to use for displaying of | |
file contents in <a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a> and <a href="gitk.html">gitk(1)</a>. | |
It can be overridden by setting the <em>encoding</em> attribute | |
for relevant files (see <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a>). | |
If this option is not set, the tools default to the | |
locale encoding. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.matchTrackingBranch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Determines if new branches created with <a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a> should | |
default to tracking remote branches with matching names or | |
not. Default: "false". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.newBranchTemplate | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Is used as suggested name when creating new branches using the | |
<a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.pruneDuringFetch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
"true" if <a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a> should prune remote-tracking branches when | |
performing a fetch. The default value is "false". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.trustmtime | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Determines if <a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a> should trust the file modification | |
timestamp or not. By default the timestamps are not trusted. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.spellingDictionary | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the dictionary used for spell checking commit messages in | |
the <a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a>. When set to "none" spell checking is turned | |
off. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.fastCopyBlame | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, <em>git gui blame</em> uses <code>-C</code> instead of <code>-C -C</code> for original | |
location detection. It makes blame significantly faster on huge | |
repositories at the expense of less thorough copy detection. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.copyBlameThreshold | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the threshold to use in <em>git gui blame</em> original location | |
detection, measured in alphanumeric characters. See the | |
<a href="git-blame.html">git-blame(1)</a> manual for more information on copy detection. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
gui.blamehistoryctx | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the radius of history context in days to show in | |
<a href="gitk.html">gitk(1)</a> for the selected commit, when the <code>Show History | |
Context</code> menu item is invoked from <em>git gui blame</em>. If this | |
variable is set to zero, the whole history is shown. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.cmd | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the shell command line to execute when the corresponding item | |
of the <a href="git-gui.html">git-gui(1)</a> <code>Tools</code> menu is invoked. This option is | |
mandatory for every tool. The command is executed from the root of | |
the working directory, and in the environment it receives the name of | |
the tool as <code>GIT_GUITOOL</code>, the name of the currently selected file as | |
<em>FILENAME</em>, and the name of the current branch as <em>CUR_BRANCH</em> (if | |
the head is detached, <em>CUR_BRANCH</em> is empty). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.needsFile | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Run the tool only if a diff is selected in the GUI. It guarantees | |
that <em>FILENAME</em> is not empty. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.noConsole | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Run the command silently, without creating a window to display its | |
output. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.noRescan | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Don’t rescan the working directory for changes after the tool | |
finishes execution. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.confirm | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Show a confirmation dialog before actually running the tool. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.argPrompt | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Request a string argument from the user, and pass it to the tool | |
through the <code>ARGS</code> environment variable. Since requesting an | |
argument implies confirmation, the <em>confirm</em> option has no effect | |
if this is enabled. If the option is set to <em>true</em>, <em>yes</em>, or <em>1</em>, | |
the dialog uses a built-in generic prompt; otherwise the exact | |
value of the variable is used. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.revPrompt | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Request a single valid revision from the user, and set the | |
<code>REVISION</code> environment variable. In other aspects this option | |
is similar to <em>argPrompt</em>, and can be used together with it. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.revUnmerged | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Show only unmerged branches in the <em>revPrompt</em> subdialog. | |
This is useful for tools similar to merge or rebase, but not | |
for things like checkout or reset. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.title | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the title to use for the prompt dialog. The default | |
is the tool name. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
guitool.<name>.prompt | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the general prompt string to display at the top of | |
the dialog, before subsections for <em>argPrompt</em> and <em>revPrompt</em>. | |
The default value includes the actual command. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
help.browser | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the browser that will be used to display help in the | |
<em>web</em> format. See <a href="git-help.html">git-help(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
help.format | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Override the default help format used by <a href="git-help.html">git-help(1)</a>. | |
Values <em>man</em>, <em>info</em>, <em>web</em> and <em>html</em> are supported. <em>man</em> is | |
the default. <em>web</em> and <em>html</em> are the same. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
help.autoCorrect | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If git detects typos and can identify exactly one valid command similar | |
to the error, git will try to suggest the correct command or even | |
run the suggestion automatically. Possible config values are: | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
0 (default): show the suggested command. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
positive number: run the suggested command after specified | |
deciseconds (0.1 sec). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
"immediate": run the suggested command immediately. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
"prompt": show the suggestion and prompt for confirmation to run | |
the command. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
"never": don’t run or show any suggested command. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
help.htmlPath | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the path where the HTML documentation resides. File system paths | |
and URLs are supported. HTML pages will be prefixed with this path when | |
help is displayed in the <em>web</em> format. This defaults to the documentation | |
path of your Git installation. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.proxy | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Override the HTTP proxy, normally configured using the <em>http_proxy</em>, | |
<em>https_proxy</em>, and <em>all_proxy</em> environment variables (see <code>curl(1)</code>). In | |
addition to the syntax understood by curl, it is possible to specify a | |
proxy string with a user name but no password, in which case git will | |
attempt to acquire one in the same way it does for other credentials. See | |
<a href="gitcredentials.html">gitcredentials(7)</a> for more information. The syntax thus is | |
<em>[protocol://][user[:password]@]proxyhost[:port]</em>. This can be overridden | |
on a per-remote basis; see remote.<name>.proxy | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.proxyAuthMethod | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set the method with which to authenticate against the HTTP proxy. This | |
only takes effect if the configured proxy string contains a user name part | |
(i.e. is of the form <em>user@host</em> or <em>user@host:port</em>). This can be | |
overridden on a per-remote basis; see <code>remote.<name>.proxyAuthMethod</code>. | |
Both can be overridden by the <code>GIT_HTTP_PROXY_AUTHMETHOD</code> environment | |
variable. Possible values are: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>anyauth</code> - Automatically pick a suitable authentication method. It is | |
assumed that the proxy answers an unauthenticated request with a 407 | |
status code and one or more Proxy-authenticate headers with supported | |
authentication methods. This is the default. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>basic</code> - HTTP Basic authentication | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>digest</code> - HTTP Digest authentication; this prevents the password from being | |
transmitted to the proxy in clear text | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>negotiate</code> - GSS-Negotiate authentication (compare the --negotiate option | |
of <code>curl(1)</code>) | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>ntlm</code> - NTLM authentication (compare the --ntlm option of <code>curl(1)</code>) | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.proxySSLCert | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The pathname of a file that stores a client certificate to use to authenticate | |
with an HTTPS proxy. Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_PROXY_SSL_CERT</code> environment | |
variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.proxySSLKey | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The pathname of a file that stores a private key to use to authenticate with | |
an HTTPS proxy. Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_PROXY_SSL_KEY</code> environment | |
variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.proxySSLCertPasswordProtected | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Enable Git’s password prompt for the proxy SSL certificate. Otherwise OpenSSL | |
will prompt the user, possibly many times, if the certificate or private key | |
is encrypted. Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_PROXY_SSL_CERT_PASSWORD_PROTECTED</code> | |
environment variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.proxySSLCAInfo | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Pathname to the file containing the certificate bundle that should be used to | |
verify the proxy with when using an HTTPS proxy. Can be overridden by the | |
<code>GIT_PROXY_SSL_CAINFO</code> environment variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.emptyAuth | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Attempt authentication without seeking a username or password. This | |
can be used to attempt GSS-Negotiate authentication without specifying | |
a username in the URL, as libcurl normally requires a username for | |
authentication. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.delegation | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Control GSSAPI credential delegation. The delegation is disabled | |
by default in libcurl since version 7.21.7. Set parameter to tell | |
the server what it is allowed to delegate when it comes to user | |
credentials. Used with GSS/kerberos. Possible values are: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>none</code> - Don’t allow any delegation. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>policy</code> - Delegates if and only if the OK-AS-DELEGATE flag is set in the | |
Kerberos service ticket, which is a matter of realm policy. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>always</code> - Unconditionally allow the server to delegate. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.extraHeader | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Pass an additional HTTP header when communicating with a server. If | |
more than one such entry exists, all of them are added as extra | |
headers. To allow overriding the settings inherited from the system | |
config, an empty value will reset the extra headers to the empty list. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.cookieFile | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The pathname of a file containing previously stored cookie lines, | |
which should be used | |
in the Git http session, if they match the server. The file format | |
of the file to read cookies from should be plain HTTP headers or | |
the Netscape/Mozilla cookie file format (see <code>curl(1)</code>). | |
NOTE that the file specified with http.cookieFile is used only as | |
input unless http.saveCookies is set. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.saveCookies | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set, store cookies received during requests to the file specified by | |
http.cookieFile. Has no effect if http.cookieFile is unset. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.version | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Use the specified HTTP protocol version when communicating with a server. | |
If you want to force the default. The available and default version depend | |
on libcurl. Currently the possible values of | |
this option are: | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
HTTP/2 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
HTTP/1.1 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslVersion | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The SSL version to use when negotiating an SSL connection, if you | |
want to force the default. The available and default version | |
depend on whether libcurl was built against NSS or OpenSSL and the | |
particular configuration of the crypto library in use. Internally | |
this sets the <em>CURLOPT_SSL_VERSION</em> option; see the libcurl | |
documentation for more details on the format of this option and | |
for the ssl version supported. Currently the possible values of | |
this option are: | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
sslv2 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
sslv3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
tlsv1 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
tlsv1.0 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
tlsv1.1 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
tlsv1.2 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
tlsv1.3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_SSL_VERSION</code> environment variable. | |
To force git to use libcurl’s default ssl version and ignore any | |
explicit http.sslversion option, set <code>GIT_SSL_VERSION</code> to the | |
empty string.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslCipherList | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A list of SSL ciphers to use when negotiating an SSL connection. | |
The available ciphers depend on whether libcurl was built against | |
NSS or OpenSSL and the particular configuration of the crypto | |
library in use. Internally this sets the <em>CURLOPT_SSL_CIPHER_LIST</em> | |
option; see the libcurl documentation for more details on the format | |
of this list. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_SSL_CIPHER_LIST</code> environment variable. | |
To force git to use libcurl’s default cipher list and ignore any | |
explicit http.sslCipherList option, set <code>GIT_SSL_CIPHER_LIST</code> to the | |
empty string.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslVerify | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether to verify the SSL certificate when fetching or pushing | |
over HTTPS. Defaults to true. Can be overridden by the | |
<code>GIT_SSL_NO_VERIFY</code> environment variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslCert | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
File containing the SSL certificate when fetching or pushing | |
over HTTPS. Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_SSL_CERT</code> environment | |
variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslKey | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
File containing the SSL private key when fetching or pushing | |
over HTTPS. Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_SSL_KEY</code> environment | |
variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslCertPasswordProtected | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Enable Git’s password prompt for the SSL certificate. Otherwise | |
OpenSSL will prompt the user, possibly many times, if the | |
certificate or private key is encrypted. Can be overridden by the | |
<code>GIT_SSL_CERT_PASSWORD_PROTECTED</code> environment variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslCAInfo | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
File containing the certificates to verify the peer with when | |
fetching or pushing over HTTPS. Can be overridden by the | |
<code>GIT_SSL_CAINFO</code> environment variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslCAPath | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Path containing files with the CA certificates to verify the peer | |
with when fetching or pushing over HTTPS. Can be overridden | |
by the <code>GIT_SSL_CAPATH</code> environment variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslBackend | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Name of the SSL backend to use (e.g. "openssl" or "schannel"). | |
This option is ignored if cURL lacks support for choosing the SSL | |
backend at runtime. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.schannelCheckRevoke | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Used to enforce or disable certificate revocation checks in cURL | |
when http.sslBackend is set to "schannel". Defaults to <code>true</code> if | |
unset. Only necessary to disable this if Git consistently errors | |
and the message is about checking the revocation status of a | |
certificate. This option is ignored if cURL lacks support for | |
setting the relevant SSL option at runtime. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.schannelUseSSLCAInfo | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
As of cURL v7.60.0, the Secure Channel backend can use the | |
certificate bundle provided via <code>http.sslCAInfo</code>, but that would | |
override the Windows Certificate Store. Since this is not desirable | |
by default, Git will tell cURL not to use that bundle by default | |
when the <code>schannel</code> backend was configured via <code>http.sslBackend</code>, | |
unless <code>http.schannelUseSSLCAInfo</code> overrides this behavior. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.pinnedpubkey | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Public key of the https service. It may either be the filename of | |
a PEM or DER encoded public key file or a string starting with | |
<em>sha256//</em> followed by the base64 encoded sha256 hash of the | |
public key. See also libcurl <em>CURLOPT_PINNEDPUBLICKEY</em>. git will | |
exit with an error if this option is set but not supported by | |
cURL. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.sslTry | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Attempt to use AUTH SSL/TLS and encrypted data transfers | |
when connecting via regular FTP protocol. This might be needed | |
if the FTP server requires it for security reasons or you wish | |
to connect securely whenever remote FTP server supports it. | |
Default is false since it might trigger certificate verification | |
errors on misconfigured servers. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.maxRequests | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
How many HTTP requests to launch in parallel. Can be overridden | |
by the <code>GIT_HTTP_MAX_REQUESTS</code> environment variable. Default is 5. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.minSessions | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The number of curl sessions (counted across slots) to be kept across | |
requests. They will not be ended with curl_easy_cleanup() until | |
http_cleanup() is invoked. If USE_CURL_MULTI is not defined, this | |
value will be capped at 1. Defaults to 1. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.postBuffer | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Maximum size in bytes of the buffer used by smart HTTP | |
transports when POSTing data to the remote system. | |
For requests larger than this buffer size, HTTP/1.1 and | |
Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used to avoid creating a | |
massive pack file locally. Default is 1 MiB, which is | |
sufficient for most requests. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that raising this limit is only effective for disabling chunked | |
transfer encoding and therefore should be used only where the remote | |
server or a proxy only supports HTTP/1.0 or is noncompliant with the | |
HTTP standard. Raising this is not, in general, an effective solution | |
for most push problems, but can increase memory consumption | |
significantly since the entire buffer is allocated even for small | |
pushes.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.lowSpeedLimit, http.lowSpeedTime | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If the HTTP transfer speed is less than <em>http.lowSpeedLimit</em> | |
for longer than <em>http.lowSpeedTime</em> seconds, the transfer is aborted. | |
Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_HTTP_LOW_SPEED_LIMIT</code> and | |
<code>GIT_HTTP_LOW_SPEED_TIME</code> environment variables. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.noEPSV | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean which disables using of EPSV ftp command by curl. | |
This can helpful with some "poor" ftp servers which don’t | |
support EPSV mode. Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_CURL_FTP_NO_EPSV</code> | |
environment variable. Default is false (curl will use EPSV). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.userAgent | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The HTTP USER_AGENT string presented to an HTTP server. The default | |
value represents the version of the client Git such as git/1.7.1. | |
This option allows you to override this value to a more common value | |
such as Mozilla/4.0. This may be necessary, for instance, if | |
connecting through a firewall that restricts HTTP connections to a set | |
of common USER_AGENT strings (but not including those like git/1.7.1). | |
Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_HTTP_USER_AGENT</code> environment variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.followRedirects | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether git should follow HTTP redirects. If set to <code>true</code>, git | |
will transparently follow any redirect issued by a server it | |
encounters. If set to <code>false</code>, git will treat all redirects as | |
errors. If set to <code>initial</code>, git will follow redirects only for | |
the initial request to a remote, but not for subsequent | |
follow-up HTTP requests. Since git uses the redirected URL as | |
the base for the follow-up requests, this is generally | |
sufficient. The default is <code>initial</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
http.<url>.* | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Any of the http.* options above can be applied selectively to some URLs. | |
For a config key to match a URL, each element of the config key is | |
compared to that of the URL, in the following order: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic"> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
Scheme (e.g., <code>https</code> in <code>https://example.com/</code>). This field | |
must match exactly between the config key and the URL. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
Host/domain name (e.g., <code>example.com</code> in <code>https://example.com/</code>). | |
This field must match between the config key and the URL. It is | |
possible to specify a <code>*</code> as part of the host name to match all subdomains | |
at this level. <code>https://*.example.com/</code> for example would match | |
<code>https://foo.example.com/</code>, but not <code>https://foo.bar.example.com/</code>. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
Port number (e.g., <code>8080</code> in <code>http://example.com:8080/</code>). | |
This field must match exactly between the config key and the URL. | |
Omitted port numbers are automatically converted to the correct | |
default for the scheme before matching. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
Path (e.g., <code>repo.git</code> in <code>https://example.com/repo.git</code>). The | |
path field of the config key must match the path field of the URL | |
either exactly or as a prefix of slash-delimited path elements. This means | |
a config key with path <code>foo/</code> matches URL path <code>foo/bar</code>. A prefix can only | |
match on a slash (<code>/</code>) boundary. Longer matches take precedence (so a config | |
key with path <code>foo/bar</code> is a better match to URL path <code>foo/bar</code> than a config | |
key with just path <code>foo/</code>). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
User name (e.g., <code>user</code> in <code>https://user@example.com/repo.git</code>). If | |
the config key has a user name it must match the user name in the | |
URL exactly. If the config key does not have a user name, that | |
config key will match a URL with any user name (including none), | |
but at a lower precedence than a config key with a user name. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ol></div> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The list above is ordered by decreasing precedence; a URL that matches | |
a config key’s path is preferred to one that matches its user name. For example, | |
if the URL is <code>https://user@example.com/foo/bar</code> a config key match of | |
<code>https://example.com/foo</code> will be preferred over a config key match of | |
<code>https://user@example.com</code>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>All URLs are normalized before attempting any matching (the password part, | |
if embedded in the URL, is always ignored for matching purposes) so that | |
equivalent URLs that are simply spelled differently will match properly. | |
Environment variable settings always override any matches. The URLs that are | |
matched against are those given directly to Git commands. This means any URLs | |
visited as a result of a redirection do not participate in matching.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
i18n.commitEncoding | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Character encoding the commit messages are stored in; Git itself | |
does not care per se, but this information is necessary e.g. when | |
importing commits from emails or in the gitk graphical history | |
browser (and possibly at other places in the future or in other | |
porcelains). See e.g. <a href="git-mailinfo.html">git-mailinfo(1)</a>. Defaults to <em>utf-8</em>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
i18n.logOutputEncoding | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Character encoding the commit messages are converted to when | |
running <em>git log</em> and friends. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
imap.folder | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The folder to drop the mails into, which is typically the Drafts | |
folder. For example: "INBOX.Drafts", "INBOX/Drafts" or | |
"[Gmail]/Drafts". Required. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
imap.tunnel | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Command used to setup a tunnel to the IMAP server through which | |
commands will be piped instead of using a direct network connection | |
to the server. Required when imap.host is not set. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
imap.host | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A URL identifying the server. Use an <code>imap://</code> prefix for non-secure | |
connections and an <code>imaps://</code> prefix for secure connections. | |
Ignored when imap.tunnel is set, but required otherwise. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
imap.user | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The username to use when logging in to the server. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
imap.pass | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The password to use when logging in to the server. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
imap.port | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
An integer port number to connect to on the server. | |
Defaults to 143 for imap:// hosts and 993 for imaps:// hosts. | |
Ignored when imap.tunnel is set. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
imap.sslverify | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to enable/disable verification of the server certificate | |
used by the SSL/TLS connection. Default is <code>true</code>. Ignored when | |
imap.tunnel is set. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
imap.preformattedHTML | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to enable/disable the use of html encoding when sending | |
a patch. An html encoded patch will be bracketed with <pre> | |
and have a content type of text/html. Ironically, enabling this | |
option causes Thunderbird to send the patch as a plain/text, | |
format=fixed email. Default is <code>false</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
imap.authMethod | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify authenticate method for authentication with IMAP server. | |
If Git was built with the NO_CURL option, or if your curl version is older | |
than 7.34.0, or if you’re running git-imap-send with the <code>--no-curl</code> | |
option, the only supported method is <em>CRAM-MD5</em>. If this is not set | |
then <em>git imap-send</em> uses the basic IMAP plaintext LOGIN command. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
index.recordEndOfIndexEntries | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies whether the index file should include an "End Of Index | |
Entry" section. This reduces index load time on multiprocessor | |
machines but produces a message "ignoring EOIE extension" when | |
reading the index using Git versions before 2.20. Defaults to | |
<em>true</em> if index.threads has been explicitly enabled, <em>false</em> | |
otherwise. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
index.recordOffsetTable | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies whether the index file should include an "Index Entry | |
Offset Table" section. This reduces index load time on | |
multiprocessor machines but produces a message "ignoring IEOT | |
extension" when reading the index using Git versions before 2.20. | |
Defaults to <em>true</em> if index.threads has been explicitly enabled, | |
<em>false</em> otherwise. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
index.sparse | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When enabled, write the index using sparse-directory entries. This | |
has no effect unless <code>core.sparseCheckout</code> and | |
<code>core.sparseCheckoutCone</code> are both enabled. Defaults to <em>false</em>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
index.threads | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the number of threads to spawn when loading the index. | |
This is meant to reduce index load time on multiprocessor machines. | |
Specifying 0 or <em>true</em> will cause Git to auto-detect the number of | |
CPU’s and set the number of threads accordingly. Specifying 1 or | |
<em>false</em> will disable multithreading. Defaults to <em>true</em>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
index.version | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the version with which new index files should be | |
initialized. This does not affect existing repositories. | |
If <code>feature.manyFiles</code> is enabled, then the default is 4. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
init.templateDir | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the directory from which templates will be copied. | |
(See the "TEMPLATE DIRECTORY" section of <a href="git-init.html">git-init(1)</a>.) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
init.defaultBranch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Allows overriding the default branch name e.g. when initializing | |
a new repository. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
instaweb.browser | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the program that will be used to browse your working | |
repository in gitweb. See <a href="git-instaweb.html">git-instaweb(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
instaweb.httpd | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The HTTP daemon command-line to start gitweb on your working | |
repository. See <a href="git-instaweb.html">git-instaweb(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
instaweb.local | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true the web server started by <a href="git-instaweb.html">git-instaweb(1)</a> will | |
be bound to the local IP (127.0.0.1). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
instaweb.modulePath | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default module path for <a href="git-instaweb.html">git-instaweb(1)</a> to use | |
instead of /usr/lib/apache2/modules. Only used if httpd | |
is Apache. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
instaweb.port | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The port number to bind the gitweb httpd to. See | |
<a href="git-instaweb.html">git-instaweb(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
interactive.singleKey | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
In interactive commands, allow the user to provide one-letter | |
input with a single key (i.e., without hitting enter). | |
Currently this is used by the <code>--patch</code> mode of | |
<a href="git-add.html">git-add(1)</a>, <a href="git-checkout.html">git-checkout(1)</a>, | |
<a href="git-restore.html">git-restore(1)</a>, <a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a>, | |
<a href="git-reset.html">git-reset(1)</a>, and <a href="git-stash.html">git-stash(1)</a>. Note that this | |
setting is silently ignored if portable keystroke input | |
is not available; requires the Perl module Term::ReadKey. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
interactive.diffFilter | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When an interactive command (such as <code>git add --patch</code>) shows | |
a colorized diff, git will pipe the diff through the shell | |
command defined by this configuration variable. The command may | |
mark up the diff further for human consumption, provided that it | |
retains a one-to-one correspondence with the lines in the | |
original diff. Defaults to disabled (no filtering). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.abbrevCommit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, makes <a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a>, <a href="git-show.html">git-show(1)</a>, and | |
<a href="git-whatchanged.html">git-whatchanged(1)</a> assume <code>--abbrev-commit</code>. You may | |
override this option with <code>--no-abbrev-commit</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.date | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set the default date-time mode for the <em>log</em> command. | |
Setting a value for log.date is similar to using <em>git log</em>'s | |
<code>--date</code> option. See <a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.decorate | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Print out the ref names of any commits that are shown by the log | |
command. If <em>short</em> is specified, the ref name prefixes <em>refs/heads/</em>, | |
<em>refs/tags/</em> and <em>refs/remotes/</em> will not be printed. If <em>full</em> is | |
specified, the full ref name (including prefix) will be printed. | |
If <em>auto</em> is specified, then if the output is going to a terminal, | |
the ref names are shown as if <em>short</em> were given, otherwise no ref | |
names are shown. This is the same as the <code>--decorate</code> option | |
of the <code>git log</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.excludeDecoration | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Exclude the specified patterns from the log decorations. This is | |
similar to the <code>--decorate-refs-exclude</code> command-line option, but | |
the config option can be overridden by the <code>--decorate-refs</code> | |
option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.diffMerges | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set default diff format to be used for merge commits. See | |
<code>--diff-merges</code> in <a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a> for details. | |
Defaults to <code>separate</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.follow | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If <code>true</code>, <code>git log</code> will act as if the <code>--follow</code> option was used when | |
a single <path> is given. This has the same limitations as <code>--follow</code>, | |
i.e. it cannot be used to follow multiple files and does not work well | |
on non-linear history. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.graphColors | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A list of colors, separated by commas, that can be used to draw | |
history lines in <code>git log --graph</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.showRoot | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, the initial commit will be shown as a big creation event. | |
This is equivalent to a diff against an empty tree. | |
Tools like <a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a> or <a href="git-whatchanged.html">git-whatchanged(1)</a>, which | |
normally hide the root commit will now show it. True by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.showSignature | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, makes <a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a>, <a href="git-show.html">git-show(1)</a>, and | |
<a href="git-whatchanged.html">git-whatchanged(1)</a> assume <code>--show-signature</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
log.mailmap | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, makes <a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a>, <a href="git-show.html">git-show(1)</a>, and | |
<a href="git-whatchanged.html">git-whatchanged(1)</a> assume <code>--use-mailmap</code>, otherwise | |
assume <code>--no-use-mailmap</code>. True by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
lsrefs.unborn | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
May be "advertise" (the default), "allow", or "ignore". If "advertise", | |
the server will respond to the client sending "unborn" (as described in | |
protocol-v2.txt) and will advertise support for this feature during the | |
protocol v2 capability advertisement. "allow" is the same as | |
"advertise" except that the server will not advertise support for this | |
feature; this is useful for load-balanced servers that cannot be | |
updated atomically (for example), since the administrator could | |
configure "allow", then after a delay, configure "advertise". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mailinfo.scissors | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, makes <a href="git-mailinfo.html">git-mailinfo(1)</a> (and therefore | |
<a href="git-am.html">git-am(1)</a>) act by default as if the --scissors option | |
was provided on the command-line. When active, this features | |
removes everything from the message body before a scissors | |
line (i.e. consisting mainly of ">8", "8<" and "-"). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mailmap.file | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The location of an augmenting mailmap file. The default | |
mailmap, located in the root of the repository, is loaded | |
first, then the mailmap file pointed to by this variable. | |
The location of the mailmap file may be in a repository | |
subdirectory, or somewhere outside of the repository itself. | |
See <a href="git-shortlog.html">git-shortlog(1)</a> and <a href="git-blame.html">git-blame(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mailmap.blob | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Like <code>mailmap.file</code>, but consider the value as a reference to a | |
blob in the repository. If both <code>mailmap.file</code> and | |
<code>mailmap.blob</code> are given, both are parsed, with entries from | |
<code>mailmap.file</code> taking precedence. In a bare repository, this | |
defaults to <code>HEAD:.mailmap</code>. In a non-bare repository, it | |
defaults to empty. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
maintenance.auto | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This boolean config option controls whether some commands run | |
<code>git maintenance run --auto</code> after doing their normal work. Defaults | |
to true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
maintenance.strategy | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This string config option provides a way to specify one of a few | |
recommended schedules for background maintenance. This only affects | |
which tasks are run during <code>git maintenance run --schedule=X</code> | |
commands, provided no <code>--task=<task></code> arguments are provided. | |
Further, if a <code>maintenance.<task>.schedule</code> config value is set, | |
then that value is used instead of the one provided by | |
<code>maintenance.strategy</code>. The possible strategy strings are: | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>none</code>: This default setting implies no task are run at any schedule. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>incremental</code>: This setting optimizes for performing small maintenance | |
activities that do not delete any data. This does not schedule the <code>gc</code> | |
task, but runs the <code>prefetch</code> and <code>commit-graph</code> tasks hourly, the | |
<code>loose-objects</code> and <code>incremental-repack</code> tasks daily, and the <code>pack-refs</code> | |
task weekly. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
maintenance.<task>.enabled | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This boolean config option controls whether the maintenance task | |
with name <code><task></code> is run when no <code>--task</code> option is specified to | |
<code>git maintenance run</code>. These config values are ignored if a | |
<code>--task</code> option exists. By default, only <code>maintenance.gc.enabled</code> | |
is true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
maintenance.<task>.schedule | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This config option controls whether or not the given <code><task></code> runs | |
during a <code>git maintenance run --schedule=<frequency></code> command. The | |
value must be one of "hourly", "daily", or "weekly". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
maintenance.commit-graph.auto | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This integer config option controls how often the <code>commit-graph</code> task | |
should be run as part of <code>git maintenance run --auto</code>. If zero, then | |
the <code>commit-graph</code> task will not run with the <code>--auto</code> option. A | |
negative value will force the task to run every time. Otherwise, a | |
positive value implies the command should run when the number of | |
reachable commits that are not in the commit-graph file is at least | |
the value of <code>maintenance.commit-graph.auto</code>. The default value is | |
100. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
maintenance.loose-objects.auto | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This integer config option controls how often the <code>loose-objects</code> task | |
should be run as part of <code>git maintenance run --auto</code>. If zero, then | |
the <code>loose-objects</code> task will not run with the <code>--auto</code> option. A | |
negative value will force the task to run every time. Otherwise, a | |
positive value implies the command should run when the number of | |
loose objects is at least the value of <code>maintenance.loose-objects.auto</code>. | |
The default value is 100. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
maintenance.incremental-repack.auto | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This integer config option controls how often the <code>incremental-repack</code> | |
task should be run as part of <code>git maintenance run --auto</code>. If zero, | |
then the <code>incremental-repack</code> task will not run with the <code>--auto</code> | |
option. A negative value will force the task to run every time. | |
Otherwise, a positive value implies the command should run when the | |
number of pack-files not in the multi-pack-index is at least the value | |
of <code>maintenance.incremental-repack.auto</code>. The default value is 10. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
man.viewer | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the programs that may be used to display help in the | |
<em>man</em> format. See <a href="git-help.html">git-help(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
man.<tool>.cmd | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the command to invoke the specified man viewer. The | |
specified command is evaluated in shell with the man page | |
passed as argument. (See <a href="git-help.html">git-help(1)</a>.) | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
man.<tool>.path | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Override the path for the given tool that may be used to | |
display help in the <em>man</em> format. See <a href="git-help.html">git-help(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.conflictStyle | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the style in which conflicted hunks are written out to | |
working tree files upon merge. The default is "merge", which | |
shows a <code><<<<<<<</code> conflict marker, changes made by one side, | |
a <code>=======</code> marker, changes made by the other side, and then | |
a <code>>>>>>>></code> marker. An alternate style, "diff3", adds a <code>|||||||</code> | |
marker and the original text before the <code>=======</code> marker. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.defaultToUpstream | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If merge is called without any commit argument, merge the upstream | |
branches configured for the current branch by using their last | |
observed values stored in their remote-tracking branches. | |
The values of the <code>branch.<current branch>.merge</code> that name the | |
branches at the remote named by <code>branch.<current branch>.remote</code> | |
are consulted, and then they are mapped via <code>remote.<remote>.fetch</code> | |
to their corresponding remote-tracking branches, and the tips of | |
these tracking branches are merged. Defaults to true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.ff | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default, Git does not create an extra merge commit when merging | |
a commit that is a descendant of the current commit. Instead, the | |
tip of the current branch is fast-forwarded. When set to <code>false</code>, | |
this variable tells Git to create an extra merge commit in such | |
a case (equivalent to giving the <code>--no-ff</code> option from the command | |
line). When set to <code>only</code>, only such fast-forward merges are | |
allowed (equivalent to giving the <code>--ff-only</code> option from the | |
command line). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.verifySignatures | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, this is equivalent to the --verify-signatures command | |
line option. See <a href="git-merge.html">git-merge(1)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.branchdesc | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
In addition to branch names, populate the log message with | |
the branch description text associated with them. Defaults | |
to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.log | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
In addition to branch names, populate the log message with at | |
most the specified number of one-line descriptions from the | |
actual commits that are being merged. Defaults to false, and | |
true is a synonym for 20. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.suppressDest | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By adding a glob that matches the names of integration | |
branches to this multi-valued configuration variable, the | |
default merge message computed for merges into these | |
integration branches will omit "into <branch name>" from | |
its title. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>An element with an empty value can be used to clear the list | |
of globs accumulated from previous configuration entries. | |
When there is no <code>merge.suppressDest</code> variable defined, the | |
default value of <code>master</code> is used for backward compatibility.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.renameLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The number of files to consider in the exhaustive portion of | |
rename detection during a merge. If not specified, defaults | |
to the value of diff.renameLimit. If neither | |
merge.renameLimit nor diff.renameLimit are specified, | |
currently defaults to 7000. This setting has no effect if | |
rename detection is turned off. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.renames | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether Git detects renames. If set to "false", rename detection | |
is disabled. If set to "true", basic rename detection is enabled. | |
Defaults to the value of diff.renames. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.directoryRenames | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether Git detects directory renames, affecting what happens at | |
merge time to new files added to a directory on one side of | |
history when that directory was renamed on the other side of | |
history. If merge.directoryRenames is set to "false", directory | |
rename detection is disabled, meaning that such new files will be | |
left behind in the old directory. If set to "true", directory | |
rename detection is enabled, meaning that such new files will be | |
moved into the new directory. If set to "conflict", a conflict | |
will be reported for such paths. If merge.renames is false, | |
merge.directoryRenames is ignored and treated as false. Defaults | |
to "conflict". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.renormalize | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Tell Git that canonical representation of files in the | |
repository has changed over time (e.g. earlier commits record | |
text files with CRLF line endings, but recent ones use LF line | |
endings). In such a repository, Git can convert the data | |
recorded in commits to a canonical form before performing a | |
merge to reduce unnecessary conflicts. For more information, | |
see section "Merging branches with differing checkin/checkout | |
attributes" in <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.stat | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether to print the diffstat between ORIG_HEAD and the merge result | |
at the end of the merge. True by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.autoStash | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to true, automatically create a temporary stash entry | |
before the operation begins, and apply it after the operation | |
ends. This means that you can run merge on a dirty worktree. | |
However, use with care: the final stash application after a | |
successful merge might result in non-trivial conflicts. | |
This option can be overridden by the <code>--no-autostash</code> and | |
<code>--autostash</code> options of <a href="git-merge.html">git-merge(1)</a>. | |
Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.tool | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Controls which merge tool is used by <a href="git-mergetool.html">git-mergetool(1)</a>. | |
The list below shows the valid built-in values. | |
Any other value is treated as a custom merge tool and requires | |
that a corresponding mergetool.<tool>.cmd variable is defined. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.guitool | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Controls which merge tool is used by <a href="git-mergetool.html">git-mergetool(1)</a> when the | |
-g/--gui flag is specified. The list below shows the valid built-in values. | |
Any other value is treated as a custom merge tool and requires that a | |
corresponding mergetool.<guitool>.cmd variable is defined. | |
</p> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
araxis | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
bc | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
bc3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
bc4 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
codecompare | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
deltawalker | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
diffmerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
diffuse | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
ecmerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
emerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
examdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
guiffy | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
gvimdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
gvimdiff1 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
gvimdiff2 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
gvimdiff3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
kdiff3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
meld | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
nvimdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
nvimdiff1 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
nvimdiff2 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
nvimdiff3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
opendiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
p4merge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
smerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
tkdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
tortoisemerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
vimdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
vimdiff1 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
vimdiff2 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
vimdiff3 | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
winmerge | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
xxdiff | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.verbosity | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Controls the amount of output shown by the recursive merge | |
strategy. Level 0 outputs nothing except a final error | |
message if conflicts were detected. Level 1 outputs only | |
conflicts, 2 outputs conflicts and file changes. Level 5 and | |
above outputs debugging information. The default is level 2. | |
Can be overridden by the <code>GIT_MERGE_VERBOSITY</code> environment variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.<driver>.name | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Defines a human-readable name for a custom low-level | |
merge driver. See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.<driver>.driver | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Defines the command that implements a custom low-level | |
merge driver. See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
merge.<driver>.recursive | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Names a low-level merge driver to be used when | |
performing an internal merge between common ancestors. | |
See <a href="gitattributes.html">gitattributes(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.<tool>.path | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Override the path for the given tool. This is useful in case | |
your tool is not in the PATH. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.<tool>.cmd | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the command to invoke the specified merge tool. The | |
specified command is evaluated in shell with the following | |
variables available: <em>BASE</em> is the name of a temporary file | |
containing the common base of the files to be merged, if available; | |
<em>LOCAL</em> is the name of a temporary file containing the contents of | |
the file on the current branch; <em>REMOTE</em> is the name of a temporary | |
file containing the contents of the file from the branch being | |
merged; <em>MERGED</em> contains the name of the file to which the merge | |
tool should write the results of a successful merge. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.<tool>.hideResolved | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Allows the user to override the global <code>mergetool.hideResolved</code> value | |
for a specific tool. See <code>mergetool.hideResolved</code> for the full | |
description. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.<tool>.trustExitCode | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
For a custom merge command, specify whether the exit code of | |
the merge command can be used to determine whether the merge was | |
successful. If this is not set to true then the merge target file | |
timestamp is checked and the merge assumed to have been successful | |
if the file has been updated, otherwise the user is prompted to | |
indicate the success of the merge. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.meld.hasOutput | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Older versions of <code>meld</code> do not support the <code>--output</code> option. | |
Git will attempt to detect whether <code>meld</code> supports <code>--output</code> | |
by inspecting the output of <code>meld --help</code>. Configuring | |
<code>mergetool.meld.hasOutput</code> will make Git skip these checks and | |
use the configured value instead. Setting <code>mergetool.meld.hasOutput</code> | |
to <code>true</code> tells Git to unconditionally use the <code>--output</code> option, | |
and <code>false</code> avoids using <code>--output</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.meld.useAutoMerge | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When the <code>--auto-merge</code> is given, meld will merge all non-conflicting | |
parts automatically, highlight the conflicting parts and wait for | |
user decision. Setting <code>mergetool.meld.useAutoMerge</code> to <code>true</code> tells | |
Git to unconditionally use the <code>--auto-merge</code> option with <code>meld</code>. | |
Setting this value to <code>auto</code> makes git detect whether <code>--auto-merge</code> | |
is supported and will only use <code>--auto-merge</code> when available. A | |
value of <code>false</code> avoids using <code>--auto-merge</code> altogether, and is the | |
default value. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.hideResolved | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
During a merge Git will automatically resolve as many conflicts as | |
possible and write the <em>MERGED</em> file containing conflict markers around | |
any conflicts that it cannot resolve; <em>LOCAL</em> and <em>REMOTE</em> normally | |
represent the versions of the file from before Git’s conflict | |
resolution. This flag causes <em>LOCAL</em> and <em>REMOTE</em> to be overwriten so | |
that only the unresolved conflicts are presented to the merge tool. Can | |
be configured per-tool via the <code>mergetool.<tool>.hideResolved</code> | |
configuration variable. Defaults to <code>false</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.keepBackup | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
After performing a merge, the original file with conflict markers | |
can be saved as a file with a <code>.orig</code> extension. If this variable | |
is set to <code>false</code> then this file is not preserved. Defaults to | |
<code>true</code> (i.e. keep the backup files). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.keepTemporaries | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When invoking a custom merge tool, Git uses a set of temporary | |
files to pass to the tool. If the tool returns an error and this | |
variable is set to <code>true</code>, then these temporary files will be | |
preserved, otherwise they will be removed after the tool has | |
exited. Defaults to <code>false</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.writeToTemp | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Git writes temporary <em>BASE</em>, <em>LOCAL</em>, and <em>REMOTE</em> versions of | |
conflicting files in the worktree by default. Git will attempt | |
to use a temporary directory for these files when set <code>true</code>. | |
Defaults to <code>false</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
mergetool.prompt | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Prompt before each invocation of the merge resolution program. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
notes.mergeStrategy | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Which merge strategy to choose by default when resolving notes | |
conflicts. Must be one of <code>manual</code>, <code>ours</code>, <code>theirs</code>, <code>union</code>, or | |
<code>cat_sort_uniq</code>. Defaults to <code>manual</code>. See "NOTES MERGE STRATEGIES" | |
section of <a href="git-notes.html">git-notes(1)</a> for more information on each strategy. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
notes.<name>.mergeStrategy | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Which merge strategy to choose when doing a notes merge into | |
refs/notes/<name>. This overrides the more general | |
"notes.mergeStrategy". See the "NOTES MERGE STRATEGIES" section in | |
<a href="git-notes.html">git-notes(1)</a> for more information on the available strategies. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
notes.displayRef | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The (fully qualified) refname from which to show notes when | |
showing commit messages. The value of this variable can be set | |
to a glob, in which case notes from all matching refs will be | |
shown. You may also specify this configuration variable | |
several times. A warning will be issued for refs that do not | |
exist, but a glob that does not match any refs is silently | |
ignored. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This setting can be overridden with the <code>GIT_NOTES_DISPLAY_REF</code> | |
environment variable, which must be a colon separated list of refs or | |
globs.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The effective value of "core.notesRef" (possibly overridden by | |
GIT_NOTES_REF) is also implicitly added to the list of refs to be | |
displayed.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
notes.rewrite.<command> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When rewriting commits with <command> (currently <code>amend</code> or | |
<code>rebase</code>) and this variable is set to <code>true</code>, Git | |
automatically copies your notes from the original to the | |
rewritten commit. Defaults to <code>true</code>, but see | |
"notes.rewriteRef" below. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
notes.rewriteMode | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When copying notes during a rewrite (see the | |
"notes.rewrite.<command>" option), determines what to do if | |
the target commit already has a note. Must be one of | |
<code>overwrite</code>, <code>concatenate</code>, <code>cat_sort_uniq</code>, or <code>ignore</code>. | |
Defaults to <code>concatenate</code>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This setting can be overridden with the <code>GIT_NOTES_REWRITE_MODE</code> | |
environment variable.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
notes.rewriteRef | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When copying notes during a rewrite, specifies the (fully | |
qualified) ref whose notes should be copied. The ref may be a | |
glob, in which case notes in all matching refs will be copied. | |
You may also specify this configuration several times. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Does not have a default value; you must configure this variable to | |
enable note rewriting. Set it to <code>refs/notes/commits</code> to enable | |
rewriting for the default commit notes.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This setting can be overridden with the <code>GIT_NOTES_REWRITE_REF</code> | |
environment variable, which must be a colon separated list of refs or | |
globs.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.window | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The size of the window used by <a href="git-pack-objects.html">git-pack-objects(1)</a> when no | |
window size is given on the command line. Defaults to 10. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.depth | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The maximum delta depth used by <a href="git-pack-objects.html">git-pack-objects(1)</a> when no | |
maximum depth is given on the command line. Defaults to 50. | |
Maximum value is 4095. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.windowMemory | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The maximum size of memory that is consumed by each thread | |
in <a href="git-pack-objects.html">git-pack-objects(1)</a> for pack window memory when | |
no limit is given on the command line. The value can be | |
suffixed with "k", "m", or "g". When left unconfigured (or | |
set explicitly to 0), there will be no limit. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.compression | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
An integer -1..9, indicating the compression level for objects | |
in a pack file. -1 is the zlib default. 0 means no | |
compression, and 1..9 are various speed/size tradeoffs, 9 being | |
slowest. If not set, defaults to core.compression. If that is | |
not set, defaults to -1, the zlib default, which is "a default | |
compromise between speed and compression (currently equivalent | |
to level 6)." | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that changing the compression level will not automatically recompress | |
all existing objects. You can force recompression by passing the -F option | |
to <a href="git-repack.html">git-repack(1)</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.allowPackReuse | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When true, and when reachability bitmaps are enabled, | |
pack-objects will try to send parts of the bitmapped packfile | |
verbatim. This can reduce memory and CPU usage to serve fetches, | |
but might result in sending a slightly larger pack. Defaults to | |
true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.island | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
An extended regular expression configuring a set of delta | |
islands. See "DELTA ISLANDS" in <a href="git-pack-objects.html">git-pack-objects(1)</a> | |
for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.islandCore | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify an island name which gets to have its objects be | |
packed first. This creates a kind of pseudo-pack at the front | |
of one pack, so that the objects from the specified island are | |
hopefully faster to copy into any pack that should be served | |
to a user requesting these objects. In practice this means | |
that the island specified should likely correspond to what is | |
the most commonly cloned in the repo. See also "DELTA ISLANDS" | |
in <a href="git-pack-objects.html">git-pack-objects(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.deltaCacheSize | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The maximum memory in bytes used for caching deltas in | |
<a href="git-pack-objects.html">git-pack-objects(1)</a> before writing them out to a pack. | |
This cache is used to speed up the writing object phase by not | |
having to recompute the final delta result once the best match | |
for all objects is found. Repacking large repositories on machines | |
which are tight with memory might be badly impacted by this though, | |
especially if this cache pushes the system into swapping. | |
A value of 0 means no limit. The smallest size of 1 byte may be | |
used to virtually disable this cache. Defaults to 256 MiB. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.deltaCacheLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The maximum size of a delta, that is cached in | |
<a href="git-pack-objects.html">git-pack-objects(1)</a>. This cache is used to speed up the | |
writing object phase by not having to recompute the final delta | |
result once the best match for all objects is found. | |
Defaults to 1000. Maximum value is 65535. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.threads | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies the number of threads to spawn when searching for best | |
delta matches. This requires that <a href="git-pack-objects.html">git-pack-objects(1)</a> | |
be compiled with pthreads otherwise this option is ignored with a | |
warning. This is meant to reduce packing time on multiprocessor | |
machines. The required amount of memory for the delta search window | |
is however multiplied by the number of threads. | |
Specifying 0 will cause Git to auto-detect the number of CPU’s | |
and set the number of threads accordingly. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.indexVersion | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify the default pack index version. Valid values are 1 for | |
legacy pack index used by Git versions prior to 1.5.2, and 2 for | |
the new pack index with capabilities for packs larger than 4 GB | |
as well as proper protection against the repacking of corrupted | |
packs. Version 2 is the default. Note that version 2 is enforced | |
and this config option ignored whenever the corresponding pack is | |
larger than 2 GB. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If you have an old Git that does not understand the version 2 <code>*.idx</code> file, | |
cloning or fetching over a non native protocol (e.g. "http") | |
that will copy both <code>*.pack</code> file and corresponding <code>*.idx</code> file from the | |
other side may give you a repository that cannot be accessed with your | |
older version of Git. If the <code>*.pack</code> file is smaller than 2 GB, however, | |
you can use <a href="git-index-pack.html">git-index-pack(1)</a> on the *.pack file to regenerate | |
the <code>*.idx</code> file.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.packSizeLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The maximum size of a pack. This setting only affects | |
packing to a file when repacking, i.e. the git:// protocol | |
is unaffected. It can be overridden by the <code>--max-pack-size</code> | |
option of <a href="git-repack.html">git-repack(1)</a>. Reaching this limit results | |
in the creation of multiple packfiles. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that this option is rarely useful, and may result in a larger total | |
on-disk size (because Git will not store deltas between packs), as well | |
as worse runtime performance (object lookup within multiple packs is | |
slower than a single pack, and optimizations like reachability bitmaps | |
cannot cope with multiple packs).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If you need to actively run Git using smaller packfiles (e.g., because your | |
filesystem does not support large files), this option may help. But if | |
your goal is to transmit a packfile over a medium that supports limited | |
sizes (e.g., removable media that cannot store the whole repository), | |
you are likely better off creating a single large packfile and splitting | |
it using a generic multi-volume archive tool (e.g., Unix <code>split</code>).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The minimum size allowed is limited to 1 MiB. The default is unlimited. | |
Common unit suffixes of <em>k</em>, <em>m</em>, or <em>g</em> are supported.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.useBitmaps | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When true, git will use pack bitmaps (if available) when packing | |
to stdout (e.g., during the server side of a fetch). Defaults to | |
true. You should not generally need to turn this off unless | |
you are debugging pack bitmaps. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.useSparse | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When true, git will default to using the <em>--sparse</em> option in | |
<em>git pack-objects</em> when the <em>--revs</em> option is present. This | |
algorithm only walks trees that appear in paths that introduce new | |
objects. This can have significant performance benefits when | |
computing a pack to send a small change. However, it is possible | |
that extra objects are added to the pack-file if the included | |
commits contain certain types of direct renames. Default is | |
<code>true</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.preferBitmapTips | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When selecting which commits will receive bitmaps, prefer a | |
commit at the tip of any reference that is a suffix of any value | |
of this configuration over any other commits in the "selection | |
window". | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that setting this configuration to <code>refs/foo</code> does not mean that | |
the commits at the tips of <code>refs/foo/bar</code> and <code>refs/foo/baz</code> will | |
necessarily be selected. This is because commits are selected for | |
bitmaps from within a series of windows of variable length.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a commit at the tip of any reference which is a suffix of any value | |
of this configuration is seen in a window, it is immediately given | |
preference over any other commit in that window.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.writeBitmaps (deprecated) | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This is a deprecated synonym for <code>repack.writeBitmaps</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.writeBitmapHashCache | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When true, git will include a "hash cache" section in the bitmap | |
index (if one is written). This cache can be used to feed git’s | |
delta heuristics, potentially leading to better deltas between | |
bitmapped and non-bitmapped objects (e.g., when serving a fetch | |
between an older, bitmapped pack and objects that have been | |
pushed since the last gc). The downside is that it consumes 4 | |
bytes per object of disk space. Defaults to true. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When writing a multi-pack reachability bitmap, no new namehashes are | |
computed; instead, any namehashes stored in an existing bitmap are | |
permuted into their appropriate location when writing a new bitmap.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pack.writeReverseIndex | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When true, git will write a corresponding .rev file (see: | |
<a href="../technical/pack-format.html">Documentation/technical/pack-format.txt</a>) | |
for each new packfile that it writes in all places except for | |
<a href="git-fast-import.html">git-fast-import(1)</a> and in the bulk checkin mechanism. | |
Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pager.<cmd> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If the value is boolean, turns on or off pagination of the | |
output of a particular Git subcommand when writing to a tty. | |
Otherwise, turns on pagination for the subcommand using the | |
pager specified by the value of <code>pager.<cmd></code>. If <code>--paginate</code> | |
or <code>--no-pager</code> is specified on the command line, it takes | |
precedence over this option. To disable pagination for all | |
commands, set <code>core.pager</code> or <code>GIT_PAGER</code> to <code>cat</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pretty.<name> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Alias for a --pretty= format string, as specified in | |
<a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a>. Any aliases defined here can be used just | |
as the built-in pretty formats could. For example, | |
running <code>git config pretty.changelog "format:* %H %s"</code> | |
would cause the invocation <code>git log --pretty=changelog</code> | |
to be equivalent to running <code>git log "--pretty=format:* %H %s"</code>. | |
Note that an alias with the same name as a built-in format | |
will be silently ignored. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
protocol.allow | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set, provide a user defined default policy for all protocols which | |
don’t explicitly have a policy (<code>protocol.<name>.allow</code>). By default, | |
if unset, known-safe protocols (http, https, git, ssh, file) have a | |
default policy of <code>always</code>, known-dangerous protocols (ext) have a | |
default policy of <code>never</code>, and all other protocols have a default | |
policy of <code>user</code>. Supported policies: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>always</code> - protocol is always able to be used. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>never</code> - protocol is never able to be used. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>user</code> - protocol is only able to be used when <code>GIT_PROTOCOL_FROM_USER</code> is | |
either unset or has a value of 1. This policy should be used when you want a | |
protocol to be directly usable by the user but don’t want it used by commands which | |
execute clone/fetch/push commands without user input, e.g. recursive | |
submodule initialization. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
protocol.<name>.allow | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set a policy to be used by protocol <code><name></code> with clone/fetch/push | |
commands. See <code>protocol.allow</code> above for the available policies. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The protocol names currently used by git are:</p></div> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>file</code>: any local file-based path (including <code>file://</code> URLs, | |
or local paths) | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>git</code>: the anonymous git protocol over a direct TCP | |
connection (or proxy, if configured) | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>ssh</code>: git over ssh (including <code>host:path</code> syntax, | |
<code>ssh://</code>, etc). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>http</code>: git over http, both "smart http" and "dumb http". | |
Note that this does <em>not</em> include <code>https</code>; if you want to configure | |
both, you must do so individually. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
any external helpers are named by their protocol (e.g., use | |
<code>hg</code> to allow the <code>git-remote-hg</code> helper) | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
protocol.version | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set, clients will attempt to communicate with a server | |
using the specified protocol version. If the server does | |
not support it, communication falls back to version 0. | |
If unset, the default is <code>2</code>. | |
Supported versions: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>0</code> - the original wire protocol. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>1</code> - the original wire protocol with the addition of a version string | |
in the initial response from the server. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>2</code> - <a href="technical/protocol-v2.html">wire protocol version 2</a>. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pull.ff | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default, Git does not create an extra merge commit when merging | |
a commit that is a descendant of the current commit. Instead, the | |
tip of the current branch is fast-forwarded. When set to <code>false</code>, | |
this variable tells Git to create an extra merge commit in such | |
a case (equivalent to giving the <code>--no-ff</code> option from the command | |
line). When set to <code>only</code>, only such fast-forward merges are | |
allowed (equivalent to giving the <code>--ff-only</code> option from the | |
command line). This setting overrides <code>merge.ff</code> when pulling. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pull.rebase | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When true, rebase branches on top of the fetched branch, instead | |
of merging the default branch from the default remote when "git | |
pull" is run. See "branch.<name>.rebase" for setting this on a | |
per-branch basis. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When <code>merges</code> (or just <em>m</em>), pass the <code>--rebase-merges</code> option to <em>git rebase</em> | |
so that the local merge commits are included in the rebase (see | |
<a href="git-rebase.html">git-rebase(1)</a> for details).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When <code>preserve</code> (or just <em>p</em>, deprecated in favor of <code>merges</code>), also pass | |
<code>--preserve-merges</code> along to <em>git rebase</em> so that locally committed merge | |
commits will not be flattened by running <em>git pull</em>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When the value is <code>interactive</code> (or just <em>i</em>), the rebase is run in interactive | |
mode.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p><strong>NOTE</strong>: this is a possibly dangerous operation; do <strong>not</strong> use | |
it unless you understand the implications (see <a href="git-rebase.html">git-rebase(1)</a> | |
for details).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pull.octopus | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default merge strategy to use when pulling multiple branches | |
at once. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
pull.twohead | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default merge strategy to use when pulling a single branch. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
push.default | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Defines the action <code>git push</code> should take if no refspec is | |
given (whether from the command-line, config, or elsewhere). | |
Different values are well-suited for | |
specific workflows; for instance, in a purely central workflow | |
(i.e. the fetch source is equal to the push destination), | |
<code>upstream</code> is probably what you want. Possible values are: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>nothing</code> - do not push anything (error out) unless a refspec is | |
given. This is primarily meant for people who want to | |
avoid mistakes by always being explicit. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>current</code> - push the current branch to update a branch with the same | |
name on the receiving end. Works in both central and non-central | |
workflows. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>upstream</code> - push the current branch back to the branch whose | |
changes are usually integrated into the current branch (which is | |
called <code>@{upstream}</code>). This mode only makes sense if you are | |
pushing to the same repository you would normally pull from | |
(i.e. central workflow). | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>tracking</code> - This is a deprecated synonym for <code>upstream</code>. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>simple</code> - pushes the current branch with the same name on the remote. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If you are working on a centralized workflow (pushing to the same repository you | |
pull from, which is typically <code>origin</code>), then you need to configure an upstream | |
branch with the same name.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This mode is the default since Git 2.0, and is the safest option suited for | |
beginners.</p></div> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>matching</code> - push all branches having the same name on both ends. | |
This makes the repository you are pushing to remember the set of | |
branches that will be pushed out (e.g. if you always push <em>maint</em> | |
and <em>master</em> there and no other branches, the repository you push | |
to will have these two branches, and your local <em>maint</em> and | |
<em>master</em> will be pushed there). | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>To use this mode effectively, you have to make sure <em>all</em> the | |
branches you would push out are ready to be pushed out before | |
running <em>git push</em>, as the whole point of this mode is to allow you | |
to push all of the branches in one go. If you usually finish work | |
on only one branch and push out the result, while other branches are | |
unfinished, this mode is not for you. Also this mode is not | |
suitable for pushing into a shared central repository, as other | |
people may add new branches there, or update the tip of existing | |
branches outside your control.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This used to be the default, but not since Git 2.0 (<code>simple</code> is the | |
new default).</p></div> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
push.followTags | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true enable <code>--follow-tags</code> option by default. You | |
may override this configuration at time of push by specifying | |
<code>--no-follow-tags</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
push.gpgSign | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
May be set to a boolean value, or the string <em>if-asked</em>. A true | |
value causes all pushes to be GPG signed, as if <code>--signed</code> is | |
passed to <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a>. The string <em>if-asked</em> causes | |
pushes to be signed if the server supports it, as if | |
<code>--signed=if-asked</code> is passed to <em>git push</em>. A false value may | |
override a value from a lower-priority config file. An explicit | |
command-line flag always overrides this config option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
push.pushOption | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When no <code>--push-option=<option></code> argument is given from the | |
command line, <code>git push</code> behaves as if each <value> of | |
this variable is given as <code>--push-option=<value></code>. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>This is a multi-valued variable, and an empty value can be used in a | |
higher priority configuration file (e.g. <code>.git/config</code> in a | |
repository) to clear the values inherited from a lower priority | |
configuration files (e.g. <code>$HOME/.gitconfig</code>).</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>Example: | |
/etc/gitconfig | |
push.pushoption = a | |
push.pushoption = b | |
~/.gitconfig | |
push.pushoption = c | |
repo/.git/config | |
push.pushoption = | |
push.pushoption = b | |
This will result in only b (a and c are cleared).</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
push.recurseSubmodules | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Make sure all submodule commits used by the revisions to be pushed | |
are available on a remote-tracking branch. If the value is <em>check</em> | |
then Git will verify that all submodule commits that changed in the | |
revisions to be pushed are available on at least one remote of the | |
submodule. If any commits are missing, the push will be aborted and | |
exit with non-zero status. If the value is <em>on-demand</em> then all | |
submodules that changed in the revisions to be pushed will be | |
pushed. If on-demand was not able to push all necessary revisions | |
it will also be aborted and exit with non-zero status. If the value | |
is <em>no</em> then default behavior of ignoring submodules when pushing | |
is retained. You may override this configuration at time of push by | |
specifying <em>--recurse-submodules=check|on-demand|no</em>. | |
If not set, <em>no</em> is used by default, unless <em>submodule.recurse</em> is | |
set (in which case a <em>true</em> value means <em>on-demand</em>). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
push.useForceIfIncludes | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to "true", it is equivalent to specifying | |
<code>--force-if-includes</code> as an option to <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a> | |
in the command line. Adding <code>--no-force-if-includes</code> at the | |
time of push overrides this configuration setting. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
push.negotiate | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to "true", attempt to reduce the size of the packfile | |
sent by rounds of negotiation in which the client and the | |
server attempt to find commits in common. If "false", Git will | |
rely solely on the server’s ref advertisement to find commits | |
in common. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rebase.backend | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Default backend to use for rebasing. Possible choices are | |
<em>apply</em> or <em>merge</em>. In the future, if the merge backend gains | |
all remaining capabilities of the apply backend, this setting | |
may become unused. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rebase.stat | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether to show a diffstat of what changed upstream since the last | |
rebase. False by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rebase.autoSquash | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true enable <code>--autosquash</code> option by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rebase.autoStash | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to true, automatically create a temporary stash entry | |
before the operation begins, and apply it after the operation | |
ends. This means that you can run rebase on a dirty worktree. | |
However, use with care: the final stash application after a | |
successful rebase might result in non-trivial conflicts. | |
This option can be overridden by the <code>--no-autostash</code> and | |
<code>--autostash</code> options of <a href="git-rebase.html">git-rebase(1)</a>. | |
Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rebase.missingCommitsCheck | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to "warn", git rebase -i will print a warning if some | |
commits are removed (e.g. a line was deleted), however the | |
rebase will still proceed. If set to "error", it will print | |
the previous warning and stop the rebase, <em>git rebase | |
--edit-todo</em> can then be used to correct the error. If set to | |
"ignore", no checking is done. | |
To drop a commit without warning or error, use the <code>drop</code> | |
command in the todo list. | |
Defaults to "ignore". | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rebase.instructionFormat | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A format string, as specified in <a href="git-log.html">git-log(1)</a>, to be used for the | |
todo list during an interactive rebase. The format will | |
automatically have the long commit hash prepended to the format. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rebase.abbreviateCommands | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, <code>git rebase</code> will use abbreviated command names in the | |
todo list resulting in something like this: | |
</p> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code> p deadbee The oneline of the commit | |
p fa1afe1 The oneline of the next commit | |
...</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>instead of:</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code> pick deadbee The oneline of the commit | |
pick fa1afe1 The oneline of the next commit | |
...</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Defaults to false.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rebase.rescheduleFailedExec | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Automatically reschedule <code>exec</code> commands that failed. This only makes | |
sense in interactive mode (or when an <code>--exec</code> option was provided). | |
This is the same as specifying the <code>--reschedule-failed-exec</code> option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rebase.forkPoint | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to false set <code>--no-fork-point</code> option by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.advertiseAtomic | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default, git-receive-pack will advertise the atomic push | |
capability to its clients. If you don’t want to advertise this | |
capability, set this variable to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.advertisePushOptions | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to true, git-receive-pack will advertise the push options | |
capability to its clients. False by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.autogc | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default, git-receive-pack will run "git-gc --auto" after | |
receiving data from git-push and updating refs. You can stop | |
it by setting this variable to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.certNonceSeed | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By setting this variable to a string, <code>git receive-pack</code> | |
will accept a <code>git push --signed</code> and verifies it by using | |
a "nonce" protected by HMAC using this string as a secret | |
key. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.certNonceSlop | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When a <code>git push --signed</code> sent a push certificate with a | |
"nonce" that was issued by a receive-pack serving the same | |
repository within this many seconds, export the "nonce" | |
found in the certificate to <code>GIT_PUSH_CERT_NONCE</code> to the | |
hooks (instead of what the receive-pack asked the sending | |
side to include). This may allow writing checks in | |
<code>pre-receive</code> and <code>post-receive</code> a bit easier. Instead of | |
checking <code>GIT_PUSH_CERT_NONCE_SLOP</code> environment variable | |
that records by how many seconds the nonce is stale to | |
decide if they want to accept the certificate, they only | |
can check <code>GIT_PUSH_CERT_NONCE_STATUS</code> is <code>OK</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.fsckObjects | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If it is set to true, git-receive-pack will check all received | |
objects. See <code>transfer.fsckObjects</code> for what’s checked. | |
Defaults to false. If not set, the value of | |
<code>transfer.fsckObjects</code> is used instead. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.fsck.<msg-id> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Acts like <code>fsck.<msg-id></code>, but is used by | |
<a href="git-receive-pack.html">git-receive-pack(1)</a> instead of | |
<a href="git-fsck.html">git-fsck(1)</a>. See the <code>fsck.<msg-id></code> documentation for | |
details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.fsck.skipList | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Acts like <code>fsck.skipList</code>, but is used by | |
<a href="git-receive-pack.html">git-receive-pack(1)</a> instead of | |
<a href="git-fsck.html">git-fsck(1)</a>. See the <code>fsck.skipList</code> documentation for | |
details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.keepAlive | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
After receiving the pack from the client, <code>receive-pack</code> may | |
produce no output (if <code>--quiet</code> was specified) while processing | |
the pack, causing some networks to drop the TCP connection. | |
With this option set, if <code>receive-pack</code> does not transmit | |
any data in this phase for <code>receive.keepAlive</code> seconds, it will | |
send a short keepalive packet. The default is 5 seconds; set | |
to 0 to disable keepalives entirely. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.unpackLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If the number of objects received in a push is below this | |
limit then the objects will be unpacked into loose object | |
files. However if the number of received objects equals or | |
exceeds this limit then the received pack will be stored as | |
a pack, after adding any missing delta bases. Storing the | |
pack from a push can make the push operation complete faster, | |
especially on slow filesystems. If not set, the value of | |
<code>transfer.unpackLimit</code> is used instead. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.maxInputSize | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If the size of the incoming pack stream is larger than this | |
limit, then git-receive-pack will error out, instead of | |
accepting the pack file. If not set or set to 0, then the size | |
is unlimited. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.denyDeletes | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, git-receive-pack will deny a ref update that deletes | |
the ref. Use this to prevent such a ref deletion via a push. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.denyDeleteCurrent | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, git-receive-pack will deny a ref update that | |
deletes the currently checked out branch of a non-bare repository. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.denyCurrentBranch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true or "refuse", git-receive-pack will deny a ref update | |
to the currently checked out branch of a non-bare repository. | |
Such a push is potentially dangerous because it brings the HEAD | |
out of sync with the index and working tree. If set to "warn", | |
print a warning of such a push to stderr, but allow the push to | |
proceed. If set to false or "ignore", allow such pushes with no | |
message. Defaults to "refuse". | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Another option is "updateInstead" which will update the working | |
tree if pushing into the current branch. This option is | |
intended for synchronizing working directories when one side is not easily | |
accessible via interactive ssh (e.g. a live web site, hence the requirement | |
that the working directory be clean). This mode also comes in handy when | |
developing inside a VM to test and fix code on different Operating Systems.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>By default, "updateInstead" will refuse the push if the working tree or | |
the index have any difference from the HEAD, but the <code>push-to-checkout</code> | |
hook can be used to customize this. See <a href="githooks.html">githooks(5)</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.denyNonFastForwards | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, git-receive-pack will deny a ref update which is | |
not a fast-forward. Use this to prevent such an update via a push, | |
even if that push is forced. This configuration variable is | |
set when initializing a shared repository. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.hideRefs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This variable is the same as <code>transfer.hideRefs</code>, but applies | |
only to <code>receive-pack</code> (and so affects pushes, but not fetches). | |
An attempt to update or delete a hidden ref by <code>git push</code> is | |
rejected. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.procReceiveRefs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This is a multi-valued variable that defines reference prefixes | |
to match the commands in <code>receive-pack</code>. Commands matching the | |
prefixes will be executed by an external hook "proc-receive", | |
instead of the internal <code>execute_commands</code> function. If this | |
variable is not defined, the "proc-receive" hook will never be | |
used, and all commands will be executed by the internal | |
<code>execute_commands</code> function. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example, if this variable is set to "refs/for", pushing to reference | |
such as "refs/for/master" will not create or update a reference named | |
"refs/for/master", but may create or update a pull request directly by | |
running the hook "proc-receive".</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Optional modifiers can be provided in the beginning of the value to filter | |
commands for specific actions: create (a), modify (m), delete (d). | |
A <code>!</code> can be included in the modifiers to negate the reference prefix entry. | |
E.g.:</p></div> | |
<div class="literalblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code>git config --system --add receive.procReceiveRefs ad:refs/heads | |
git config --system --add receive.procReceiveRefs !:refs/heads</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.updateServerInfo | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, git-receive-pack will run git-update-server-info | |
after receiving data from git-push and updating refs. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
receive.shallowUpdate | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, .git/shallow can be updated when new refs | |
require new shallow roots. Otherwise those refs are rejected. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.pushDefault | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The remote to push to by default. Overrides | |
<code>branch.<name>.remote</code> for all branches, and is overridden by | |
<code>branch.<name>.pushRemote</code> for specific branches. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.url | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The URL of a remote repository. See <a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a> or | |
<a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.pushurl | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The push URL of a remote repository. See <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.proxy | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
For remotes that require curl (http, https and ftp), the URL to | |
the proxy to use for that remote. Set to the empty string to | |
disable proxying for that remote. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.proxyAuthMethod | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
For remotes that require curl (http, https and ftp), the method to use for | |
authenticating against the proxy in use (probably set in | |
<code>remote.<name>.proxy</code>). See <code>http.proxyAuthMethod</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.fetch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default set of "refspec" for <a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a>. See | |
<a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.push | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default set of "refspec" for <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a>. See | |
<a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.mirror | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, pushing to this remote will automatically behave | |
as if the <code>--mirror</code> option was given on the command line. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.skipDefaultUpdate | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, this remote will be skipped by default when updating | |
using <a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a> or the <code>update</code> subcommand of | |
<a href="git-remote.html">git-remote(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.skipFetchAll | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, this remote will be skipped by default when updating | |
using <a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a> or the <code>update</code> subcommand of | |
<a href="git-remote.html">git-remote(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.receivepack | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default program to execute on the remote side when pushing. See | |
option --receive-pack of <a href="git-push.html">git-push(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.uploadpack | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default program to execute on the remote side when fetching. See | |
option --upload-pack of <a href="git-fetch-pack.html">git-fetch-pack(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.tagOpt | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Setting this value to --no-tags disables automatic tag following when | |
fetching from remote <name>. Setting it to --tags will fetch every | |
tag from remote <name>, even if they are not reachable from remote | |
branch heads. Passing these flags directly to <a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a> can | |
override this setting. See options --tags and --no-tags of | |
<a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.vcs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Setting this to a value <vcs> will cause Git to interact with | |
the remote with the git-remote-<vcs> helper. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.prune | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to true, fetching from this remote by default will also | |
remove any remote-tracking references that no longer exist on the | |
remote (as if the <code>--prune</code> option was given on the command line). | |
Overrides <code>fetch.prune</code> settings, if any. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.pruneTags | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to true, fetching from this remote by default will also | |
remove any local tags that no longer exist on the remote if pruning | |
is activated in general via <code>remote.<name>.prune</code>, <code>fetch.prune</code> or | |
<code>--prune</code>. Overrides <code>fetch.pruneTags</code> settings, if any. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <code>remote.<name>.prune</code> and the PRUNING section of | |
<a href="git-fetch.html">git-fetch(1)</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.promisor | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to true, this remote will be used to fetch promisor | |
objects. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remote.<name>.partialclonefilter | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The filter that will be applied when fetching from this | |
promisor remote. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
remotes.<group> | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The list of remotes which are fetched by "git remote update | |
<group>". See <a href="git-remote.html">git-remote(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
repack.useDeltaBaseOffset | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default, <a href="git-repack.html">git-repack(1)</a> creates packs that use | |
delta-base offset. If you need to share your repository with | |
Git older than version 1.4.4, either directly or via a dumb | |
protocol such as http, then you need to set this option to | |
"false" and repack. Access from old Git versions over the | |
native protocol are unaffected by this option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
repack.packKeptObjects | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, makes <code>git repack</code> act as if | |
<code>--pack-kept-objects</code> was passed. See <a href="git-repack.html">git-repack(1)</a> for | |
details. Defaults to <code>false</code> normally, but <code>true</code> if a bitmap | |
index is being written (either via <code>--write-bitmap-index</code> or | |
<code>repack.writeBitmaps</code>). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
repack.useDeltaIslands | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, makes <code>git repack</code> act as if <code>--delta-islands</code> | |
was passed. Defaults to <code>false</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
repack.writeBitmaps | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When true, git will write a bitmap index when packing all | |
objects to disk (e.g., when <code>git repack -a</code> is run). This | |
index can speed up the "counting objects" phase of subsequent | |
packs created for clones and fetches, at the cost of some disk | |
space and extra time spent on the initial repack. This has | |
no effect if multiple packfiles are created. | |
Defaults to true on bare repos, false otherwise. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rerere.autoUpdate | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to true, <code>git-rerere</code> updates the index with the | |
resulting contents after it cleanly resolves conflicts using | |
previously recorded resolution. Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
rerere.enabled | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Activate recording of resolved conflicts, so that identical | |
conflict hunks can be resolved automatically, should they be | |
encountered again. By default, <a href="git-rerere.html">git-rerere(1)</a> is | |
enabled if there is an <code>rr-cache</code> directory under the | |
<code>$GIT_DIR</code>, e.g. if "rerere" was previously used in the | |
repository. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
reset.quiet | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When set to true, <em>git reset</em> will default to the <em>--quiet</em> option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.identity | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A configuration identity. When given, causes values in the | |
<em>sendemail.<identity></em> subsection to take precedence over | |
values in the <em>sendemail</em> section. The default identity is | |
the value of <code>sendemail.identity</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpEncryption | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
See <a href="git-send-email.html">git-send-email(1)</a> for description. Note that this | |
setting is not subject to the <em>identity</em> mechanism. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpsslcertpath | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Path to ca-certificates (either a directory or a single file). | |
Set it to an empty string to disable certificate verification. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.<identity>.* | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Identity-specific versions of the <em>sendemail.*</em> parameters | |
found below, taking precedence over those when this | |
identity is selected, through either the command-line or | |
<code>sendemail.identity</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.aliasesFile | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.aliasFileType | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.annotate | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.bcc | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.cc | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.ccCmd | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.chainReplyTo | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.confirm | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.envelopeSender | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.from | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.multiEdit | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.signedoffbycc | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpPass | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.suppresscc | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.suppressFrom | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.to | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.tocmd | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpDomain | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpServer | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpServerPort | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpServerOption | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpUser | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.thread | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.transferEncoding | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.validate | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.xmailer | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
See <a href="git-send-email.html">git-send-email(1)</a> for description. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.signedoffcc (deprecated) | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Deprecated alias for <code>sendemail.signedoffbycc</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpBatchSize | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Number of messages to be sent per connection, after that a relogin | |
will happen. If the value is 0 or undefined, send all messages in | |
one connection. | |
See also the <code>--batch-size</code> option of <a href="git-send-email.html">git-send-email(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.smtpReloginDelay | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Seconds wait before reconnecting to smtp server. | |
See also the <code>--relogin-delay</code> option of <a href="git-send-email.html">git-send-email(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sendemail.forbidSendmailVariables | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
To avoid common misconfiguration mistakes, <a href="git-send-email.html">git-send-email(1)</a> | |
will abort with a warning if any configuration options for "sendmail" | |
exist. Set this variable to bypass the check. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
sequence.editor | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Text editor used by <code>git rebase -i</code> for editing the rebase instruction file. | |
The value is meant to be interpreted by the shell when it is used. | |
It can be overridden by the <code>GIT_SEQUENCE_EDITOR</code> environment variable. | |
When not configured the default commit message editor is used instead. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
showBranch.default | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The default set of branches for <a href="git-show-branch.html">git-show-branch(1)</a>. | |
See <a href="git-show-branch.html">git-show-branch(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
splitIndex.maxPercentChange | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When the split index feature is used, this specifies the | |
percent of entries the split index can contain compared to the | |
total number of entries in both the split index and the shared | |
index before a new shared index is written. | |
The value should be between 0 and 100. If the value is 0 then | |
a new shared index is always written, if it is 100 a new | |
shared index is never written. | |
By default the value is 20, so a new shared index is written | |
if the number of entries in the split index would be greater | |
than 20 percent of the total number of entries. | |
See <a href="git-update-index.html">git-update-index(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
splitIndex.sharedIndexExpire | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When the split index feature is used, shared index files that | |
were not modified since the time this variable specifies will | |
be removed when a new shared index file is created. The value | |
"now" expires all entries immediately, and "never" suppresses | |
expiration altogether. | |
The default value is "2.weeks.ago". | |
Note that a shared index file is considered modified (for the | |
purpose of expiration) each time a new split-index file is | |
either created based on it or read from it. | |
See <a href="git-update-index.html">git-update-index(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
ssh.variant | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default, Git determines the command line arguments to use | |
based on the basename of the configured SSH command (configured | |
using the environment variable <code>GIT_SSH</code> or <code>GIT_SSH_COMMAND</code> or | |
the config setting <code>core.sshCommand</code>). If the basename is | |
unrecognized, Git will attempt to detect support of OpenSSH | |
options by first invoking the configured SSH command with the | |
<code>-G</code> (print configuration) option and will subsequently use | |
OpenSSH options (if that is successful) or no options besides | |
the host and remote command (if it fails). | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The config variable <code>ssh.variant</code> can be set to override this detection. | |
Valid values are <code>ssh</code> (to use OpenSSH options), <code>plink</code>, <code>putty</code>, | |
<code>tortoiseplink</code>, <code>simple</code> (no options except the host and remote command). | |
The default auto-detection can be explicitly requested using the value | |
<code>auto</code>. Any other value is treated as <code>ssh</code>. This setting can also be | |
overridden via the environment variable <code>GIT_SSH_VARIANT</code>.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>The current command-line parameters used for each variant are as | |
follows:</p></div> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>ssh</code> - [-p port] [-4] [-6] [-o option] [username@]host command | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>simple</code> - [username@]host command | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>plink</code> or <code>putty</code> - [-P port] [-4] [-6] [username@]host command | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>tortoiseplink</code> - [-P port] [-4] [-6] -batch [username@]host command | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Except for the <code>simple</code> variant, command-line parameters are likely to | |
change as git gains new features.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.relativePaths | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default, <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> shows paths relative to the | |
current directory. Setting this variable to <code>false</code> shows paths | |
relative to the repository root (this was the default for Git | |
prior to v1.5.4). | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.short | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set to true to enable --short by default in <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a>. | |
The option --no-short takes precedence over this variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.branch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set to true to enable --branch by default in <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a>. | |
The option --no-branch takes precedence over this variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.aheadBehind | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Set to true to enable <code>--ahead-behind</code> and false to enable | |
<code>--no-ahead-behind</code> by default in <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> for | |
non-porcelain status formats. Defaults to true. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.displayCommentPrefix | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> will insert a comment | |
prefix before each output line (starting with | |
<code>core.commentChar</code>, i.e. <code>#</code> by default). This was the | |
behavior of <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> in Git 1.8.4 and previous. | |
Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.renameLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The number of files to consider when performing rename detection | |
in <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> and <a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a>. Defaults to | |
the value of diff.renameLimit. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.renames | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Whether and how Git detects renames in <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> and | |
<a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a> . If set to "false", rename detection is | |
disabled. If set to "true", basic rename detection is enabled. | |
If set to "copies" or "copy", Git will detect copies, as well. | |
Defaults to the value of diff.renames. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.showStash | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If set to true, <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> will display the number of | |
entries currently stashed away. | |
Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.showUntrackedFiles | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
By default, <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> and <a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a> show | |
files which are not currently tracked by Git. Directories which | |
contain only untracked files, are shown with the directory name | |
only. Showing untracked files means that Git needs to lstat() all | |
the files in the whole repository, which might be slow on some | |
systems. So, this variable controls how the commands displays | |
the untracked files. Possible values are: | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>no</code> - Show no untracked files. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>normal</code> - Show untracked files and directories. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>all</code> - Show also individual files in untracked directories. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If this variable is not specified, it defaults to <em>normal</em>. | |
This variable can be overridden with the -u|--untracked-files option | |
of <a href="git-status.html">git-status(1)</a> and <a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a>.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
status.submoduleSummary | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Defaults to false. | |
If this is set to a non zero number or true (identical to -1 or an | |
unlimited number), the submodule summary will be enabled and a | |
summary of commits for modified submodules will be shown (see | |
--summary-limit option of <a href="git-submodule.html">git-submodule(1)</a>). Please note | |
that the summary output command will be suppressed for all | |
submodules when <code>diff.ignoreSubmodules</code> is set to <em>all</em> or only | |
for those submodules where <code>submodule.<name>.ignore=all</code>. The only | |
exception to that rule is that status and commit will show staged | |
submodule changes. To | |
also view the summary for ignored submodules you can either use | |
the --ignore-submodules=dirty command-line option or the <em>git | |
submodule summary</em> command, which shows a similar output but does | |
not honor these settings. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
stash.useBuiltin | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Unused configuration variable. Used in Git versions 2.22 to | |
2.26 as an escape hatch to enable the legacy shellscript | |
implementation of stash. Now the built-in rewrite of it in C | |
is always used. Setting this will emit a warning, to alert any | |
remaining users that setting this now does nothing. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
stash.showIncludeUntracked | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If this is set to true, the <code>git stash show</code> command will show | |
the untracked files of a stash entry. Defaults to false. See | |
description of <em>show</em> command in <a href="git-stash.html">git-stash(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
stash.showPatch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If this is set to true, the <code>git stash show</code> command without an | |
option will show the stash entry in patch form. Defaults to false. | |
See description of <em>show</em> command in <a href="git-stash.html">git-stash(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
stash.showStat | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If this is set to true, the <code>git stash show</code> command without an | |
option will show diffstat of the stash entry. Defaults to true. | |
See description of <em>show</em> command in <a href="git-stash.html">git-stash(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.<name>.url | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The URL for a submodule. This variable is copied from the .gitmodules | |
file to the git config via <em>git submodule init</em>. The user can change | |
the configured URL before obtaining the submodule via <em>git submodule | |
update</em>. If neither submodule.<name>.active or submodule.active are | |
set, the presence of this variable is used as a fallback to indicate | |
whether the submodule is of interest to git commands. | |
See <a href="git-submodule.html">git-submodule(1)</a> and <a href="gitmodules.html">gitmodules(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.<name>.update | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The method by which a submodule is updated by <em>git submodule update</em>, | |
which is the only affected command, others such as | |
<em>git checkout --recurse-submodules</em> are unaffected. It exists for | |
historical reasons, when <em>git submodule</em> was the only command to | |
interact with submodules; settings like <code>submodule.active</code> | |
and <code>pull.rebase</code> are more specific. It is populated by | |
<code>git submodule init</code> from the <a href="gitmodules.html">gitmodules(5)</a> file. | |
See description of <em>update</em> command in <a href="git-submodule.html">git-submodule(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.<name>.branch | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The remote branch name for a submodule, used by <code>git submodule | |
update --remote</code>. Set this option to override the value found in | |
the <code>.gitmodules</code> file. See <a href="git-submodule.html">git-submodule(1)</a> and | |
<a href="gitmodules.html">gitmodules(5)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.<name>.fetchRecurseSubmodules | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This option can be used to control recursive fetching of this | |
submodule. It can be overridden by using the --[no-]recurse-submodules | |
command-line option to "git fetch" and "git pull". | |
This setting will override that from in the <a href="gitmodules.html">gitmodules(5)</a> | |
file. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.<name>.ignore | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Defines under what circumstances "git status" and the diff family show | |
a submodule as modified. When set to "all", it will never be considered | |
modified (but it will nonetheless show up in the output of status and | |
commit when it has been staged), "dirty" will ignore all changes | |
to the submodules work tree and | |
takes only differences between the HEAD of the submodule and the commit | |
recorded in the superproject into account. "untracked" will additionally | |
let submodules with modified tracked files in their work tree show up. | |
Using "none" (the default when this option is not set) also shows | |
submodules that have untracked files in their work tree as changed. | |
This setting overrides any setting made in .gitmodules for this submodule, | |
both settings can be overridden on the command line by using the | |
"--ignore-submodules" option. The <em>git submodule</em> commands are not | |
affected by this setting. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.<name>.active | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Boolean value indicating if the submodule is of interest to git | |
commands. This config option takes precedence over the | |
submodule.active config option. See <a href="gitsubmodules.html">gitsubmodules(7)</a> for | |
details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.active | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A repeated field which contains a pathspec used to match against a | |
submodule’s path to determine if the submodule is of interest to git | |
commands. See <a href="gitsubmodules.html">gitsubmodules(7)</a> for details. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.recurse | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean indicating if commands should enable the <code>--recurse-submodules</code> | |
option by default. | |
Applies to all commands that support this option | |
(<code>checkout</code>, <code>fetch</code>, <code>grep</code>, <code>pull</code>, <code>push</code>, <code>read-tree</code>, <code>reset</code>, | |
<code>restore</code> and <code>switch</code>) except <code>clone</code> and <code>ls-files</code>. | |
Defaults to false. | |
When set to true, it can be deactivated via the | |
<code>--no-recurse-submodules</code> option. Note that some Git commands | |
lacking this option may call some of the above commands affected by | |
<code>submodule.recurse</code>; for instance <code>git remote update</code> will call | |
<code>git fetch</code> but does not have a <code>--no-recurse-submodules</code> option. | |
For these commands a workaround is to temporarily change the | |
configuration value by using <code>git -c submodule.recurse=0</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.fetchJobs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies how many submodules are fetched/cloned at the same time. | |
A positive integer allows up to that number of submodules fetched | |
in parallel. A value of 0 will give some reasonable default. | |
If unset, it defaults to 1. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.alternateLocation | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies how the submodules obtain alternates when submodules are | |
cloned. Possible values are <code>no</code>, <code>superproject</code>. | |
By default <code>no</code> is assumed, which doesn’t add references. When the | |
value is set to <code>superproject</code> the submodule to be cloned computes | |
its alternates location relative to the superprojects alternate. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
submodule.alternateErrorStrategy | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specifies how to treat errors with the alternates for a submodule | |
as computed via <code>submodule.alternateLocation</code>. Possible values are | |
<code>ignore</code>, <code>info</code>, <code>die</code>. Default is <code>die</code>. Note that if set to <code>ignore</code> | |
or <code>info</code>, and if there is an error with the computed alternate, the | |
clone proceeds as if no alternate was specified. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
tag.forceSignAnnotated | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to specify whether annotated tags created should be GPG signed. | |
If <code>--annotate</code> is specified on the command line, it takes | |
precedence over this option. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
tag.sort | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This variable controls the sort ordering of tags when displayed by | |
<a href="git-tag.html">git-tag(1)</a>. Without the "--sort=<value>" option provided, the | |
value of this variable will be used as the default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
tag.gpgSign | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A boolean to specify whether all tags should be GPG signed. | |
Use of this option when running in an automated script can | |
result in a large number of tags being signed. It is therefore | |
convenient to use an agent to avoid typing your gpg passphrase | |
several times. Note that this option doesn’t affect tag signing | |
behavior enabled by "-u <keyid>" or "--local-user=<keyid>" options. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
tar.umask | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This variable can be used to restrict the permission bits of | |
tar archive entries. The default is 0002, which turns off the | |
world write bit. The special value "user" indicates that the | |
archiving user’s umask will be used instead. See umask(2) and | |
<a href="git-archive.html">git-archive(1)</a>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Trace2 config settings are only read from the system and global | |
config files; repository local and worktree config files and <code>-c</code> | |
command line arguments are not respected.</p></div> | |
<div class="dlist"><dl> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.normalTarget | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This variable controls the normal target destination. | |
It may be overridden by the <code>GIT_TRACE2</code> environment variable. | |
The following table shows possible values. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.perfTarget | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This variable controls the performance target destination. | |
It may be overridden by the <code>GIT_TRACE2_PERF</code> environment variable. | |
The following table shows possible values. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.eventTarget | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This variable controls the event target destination. | |
It may be overridden by the <code>GIT_TRACE2_EVENT</code> environment variable. | |
The following table shows possible values. | |
</p> | |
<div class="openblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<div class="ulist"><ul> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>0</code> or <code>false</code> - Disables the target. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>1</code> or <code>true</code> - Writes to <code>STDERR</code>. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>[2-9]</code> - Writes to the already opened file descriptor. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code><absolute-pathname></code> - Writes to the file in append mode. If the target | |
already exists and is a directory, the traces will be written to files (one | |
per process) underneath the given directory. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
<li> | |
<p> | |
<code>af_unix:[<socket_type>:]<absolute-pathname></code> - Write to a | |
Unix DomainSocket (on platforms that support them). Socket | |
type can be either <code>stream</code> or <code>dgram</code>; if omitted Git will | |
try both. | |
</p> | |
</li> | |
</ul></div> | |
</div></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.normalBrief | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Boolean. When true <code>time</code>, <code>filename</code>, and <code>line</code> fields are | |
omitted from normal output. May be overridden by the | |
<code>GIT_TRACE2_BRIEF</code> environment variable. Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.perfBrief | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Boolean. When true <code>time</code>, <code>filename</code>, and <code>line</code> fields are | |
omitted from PERF output. May be overridden by the | |
<code>GIT_TRACE2_PERF_BRIEF</code> environment variable. Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.eventBrief | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Boolean. When true <code>time</code>, <code>filename</code>, and <code>line</code> fields are | |
omitted from event output. May be overridden by the | |
<code>GIT_TRACE2_EVENT_BRIEF</code> environment variable. Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.eventNesting | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Integer. Specifies desired depth of nested regions in the | |
event output. Regions deeper than this value will be | |
omitted. May be overridden by the <code>GIT_TRACE2_EVENT_NESTING</code> | |
environment variable. Defaults to 2. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.configParams | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A comma-separated list of patterns of "important" config | |
settings that should be recorded in the trace2 output. | |
For example, <code>core.*,remote.*.url</code> would cause the trace2 | |
output to contain events listing each configured remote. | |
May be overridden by the <code>GIT_TRACE2_CONFIG_PARAMS</code> environment | |
variable. Unset by default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.envVars | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
A comma-separated list of "important" environment variables that should | |
be recorded in the trace2 output. For example, | |
<code>GIT_HTTP_USER_AGENT,GIT_CONFIG</code> would cause the trace2 output to | |
contain events listing the overrides for HTTP user agent and the | |
location of the Git configuration file (assuming any are set). May be | |
overridden by the <code>GIT_TRACE2_ENV_VARS</code> environment variable. Unset by | |
default. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.destinationDebug | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Boolean. When true Git will print error messages when a | |
trace target destination cannot be opened for writing. | |
By default, these errors are suppressed and tracing is | |
silently disabled. May be overridden by the | |
<code>GIT_TRACE2_DST_DEBUG</code> environment variable. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
trace2.maxFiles | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Integer. When writing trace files to a target directory, do not | |
write additional traces if we would exceed this many files. Instead, | |
write a sentinel file that will block further tracing to this | |
directory. Defaults to 0, which disables this check. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
transfer.fsckObjects | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When <code>fetch.fsckObjects</code> or <code>receive.fsckObjects</code> are | |
not set, the value of this variable is used instead. | |
Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When set, the fetch or receive will abort in the case of a malformed | |
object or a link to a nonexistent object. In addition, various other | |
issues are checked for, including legacy issues (see <code>fsck.<msg-id></code>), | |
and potential security issues like the existence of a <code>.GIT</code> directory | |
or a malicious <code>.gitmodules</code> file (see the release notes for v2.2.1 | |
and v2.17.1 for details). Other sanity and security checks may be | |
added in future releases.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>On the receiving side, failing fsckObjects will make those objects | |
unreachable, see "QUARANTINE ENVIRONMENT" in | |
<a href="git-receive-pack.html">git-receive-pack(1)</a>. On the fetch side, malformed objects will | |
instead be left unreferenced in the repository.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Due to the non-quarantine nature of the <code>fetch.fsckObjects</code> | |
implementation it cannot be relied upon to leave the object store | |
clean like <code>receive.fsckObjects</code> can.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>As objects are unpacked they’re written to the object store, so there | |
can be cases where malicious objects get introduced even though the | |
"fetch" failed, only to have a subsequent "fetch" succeed because only | |
new incoming objects are checked, not those that have already been | |
written to the object store. That difference in behavior should not be | |
relied upon. In the future, such objects may be quarantined for | |
"fetch" as well.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For now, the paranoid need to find some way to emulate the quarantine | |
environment if they’d like the same protection as "push". E.g. in the | |
case of an internal mirror do the mirroring in two steps, one to fetch | |
the untrusted objects, and then do a second "push" (which will use the | |
quarantine) to another internal repo, and have internal clients | |
consume this pushed-to repository, or embargo internal fetches and | |
only allow them once a full "fsck" has run (and no new fetches have | |
happened in the meantime).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
transfer.hideRefs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
String(s) <code>receive-pack</code> and <code>upload-pack</code> use to decide which | |
refs to omit from their initial advertisements. Use more than | |
one definition to specify multiple prefix strings. A ref that is | |
under the hierarchies listed in the value of this variable is | |
excluded, and is hidden when responding to <code>git push</code> or <code>git | |
fetch</code>. See <code>receive.hideRefs</code> and <code>uploadpack.hideRefs</code> for | |
program-specific versions of this config. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>You may also include a <code>!</code> in front of the ref name to negate the entry, | |
explicitly exposing it, even if an earlier entry marked it as hidden. | |
If you have multiple hideRefs values, later entries override earlier ones | |
(and entries in more-specific config files override less-specific ones).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a namespace is in use, the namespace prefix is stripped from each | |
reference before it is matched against <code>transfer.hiderefs</code> patterns. In | |
order to match refs before stripping, add a <code>^</code> in front of the ref name. If | |
you combine <code>!</code> and <code>^</code>, <code>!</code> must be specified first.</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example, if <code>refs/heads/master</code> is specified in <code>transfer.hideRefs</code> and | |
the current namespace is <code>foo</code>, then <code>refs/namespaces/foo/refs/heads/master</code> | |
is omitted from the advertisements. If <code>uploadpack.allowRefInWant</code> is set, | |
<code>upload-pack</code> will treat <code>want-ref refs/heads/master</code> in a protocol v2 | |
<code>fetch</code> command as if <code>refs/namespaces/foo/refs/heads/master</code> did not exist. | |
<code>receive-pack</code>, on the other hand, will still advertise the object id the | |
ref is pointing to without mentioning its name (a so-called ".have" line).</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Even if you hide refs, a client may still be able to steal the target | |
objects via the techniques described in the "SECURITY" section of the | |
<a href="gitnamespaces.html">gitnamespaces(7)</a> man page; it’s best to keep private data in a | |
separate repository.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
transfer.unpackLimit | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When <code>fetch.unpackLimit</code> or <code>receive.unpackLimit</code> are | |
not set, the value of this variable is used instead. | |
The default value is 100. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
transfer.advertiseSID | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Boolean. When true, client and server processes will advertise their | |
unique session IDs to their remote counterpart. Defaults to false. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadarchive.allowUnreachable | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If true, allow clients to use <code>git archive --remote</code> to request | |
any tree, whether reachable from the ref tips or not. See the | |
discussion in the "SECURITY" section of | |
<a href="git-upload-archive.html">git-upload-archive(1)</a> for more details. Defaults to | |
<code>false</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpack.hideRefs | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
This variable is the same as <code>transfer.hideRefs</code>, but applies | |
only to <code>upload-pack</code> (and so affects only fetches, not pushes). | |
An attempt to fetch a hidden ref by <code>git fetch</code> will fail. See | |
also <code>uploadpack.allowTipSHA1InWant</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpack.allowTipSHA1InWant | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When <code>uploadpack.hideRefs</code> is in effect, allow <code>upload-pack</code> | |
to accept a fetch request that asks for an object at the tip | |
of a hidden ref (by default, such a request is rejected). | |
See also <code>uploadpack.hideRefs</code>. Even if this is false, a client | |
may be able to steal objects via the techniques described in the | |
"SECURITY" section of the <a href="gitnamespaces.html">gitnamespaces(7)</a> man page; it’s | |
best to keep private data in a separate repository. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpack.allowReachableSHA1InWant | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Allow <code>upload-pack</code> to accept a fetch request that asks for an | |
object that is reachable from any ref tip. However, note that | |
calculating object reachability is computationally expensive. | |
Defaults to <code>false</code>. Even if this is false, a client may be able | |
to steal objects via the techniques described in the "SECURITY" | |
section of the <a href="gitnamespaces.html">gitnamespaces(7)</a> man page; it’s best to | |
keep private data in a separate repository. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpack.allowAnySHA1InWant | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Allow <code>upload-pack</code> to accept a fetch request that asks for any | |
object at all. | |
Defaults to <code>false</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpack.keepAlive | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
When <code>upload-pack</code> has started <code>pack-objects</code>, there may be a | |
quiet period while <code>pack-objects</code> prepares the pack. Normally | |
it would output progress information, but if <code>--quiet</code> was used | |
for the fetch, <code>pack-objects</code> will output nothing at all until | |
the pack data begins. Some clients and networks may consider | |
the server to be hung and give up. Setting this option instructs | |
<code>upload-pack</code> to send an empty keepalive packet every | |
<code>uploadpack.keepAlive</code> seconds. Setting this option to 0 | |
disables keepalive packets entirely. The default is 5 seconds. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpack.packObjectsHook | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If this option is set, when <code>upload-pack</code> would run | |
<code>git pack-objects</code> to create a packfile for a client, it will | |
run this shell command instead. The <code>pack-objects</code> command and | |
arguments it <em>would</em> have run (including the <code>git pack-objects</code> | |
at the beginning) are appended to the shell command. The stdin | |
and stdout of the hook are treated as if <code>pack-objects</code> itself | |
was run. I.e., <code>upload-pack</code> will feed input intended for | |
<code>pack-objects</code> to the hook, and expects a completed packfile on | |
stdout. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that this configuration variable is ignored if it is seen in the | |
repository-level config (this is a safety measure against fetching from | |
untrusted repositories).</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpack.allowFilter | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If this option is set, <code>upload-pack</code> will support partial | |
clone and partial fetch object filtering. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpackfilter.allow | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Provides a default value for unspecified object filters (see: the | |
below configuration variable). If set to <code>true</code>, this will also | |
enable all filters which get added in the future. | |
Defaults to <code>true</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpackfilter.<filter>.allow | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Explicitly allow or ban the object filter corresponding to | |
<code><filter></code>, where <code><filter></code> may be one of: <code>blob:none</code>, | |
<code>blob:limit</code>, <code>object:type</code>, <code>tree</code>, <code>sparse:oid</code>, or <code>combine</code>. | |
If using combined filters, both <code>combine</code> and all of the nested | |
filter kinds must be allowed. Defaults to <code>uploadpackfilter.allow</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpackfilter.tree.maxDepth | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Only allow <code>--filter=tree:<n></code> when <code><n></code> is no more than the value of | |
<code>uploadpackfilter.tree.maxDepth</code>. If set, this also implies | |
<code>uploadpackfilter.tree.allow=true</code>, unless this configuration | |
variable had already been set. Has no effect if unset. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
uploadpack.allowRefInWant | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If this option is set, <code>upload-pack</code> will support the <code>ref-in-want</code> | |
feature of the protocol version 2 <code>fetch</code> command. This feature | |
is intended for the benefit of load-balanced servers which may | |
not have the same view of what OIDs their refs point to due to | |
replication delay. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
url.<base>.insteadOf | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Any URL that starts with this value will be rewritten to | |
start, instead, with <base>. In cases where some site serves a | |
large number of repositories, and serves them with multiple | |
access methods, and some users need to use different access | |
methods, this feature allows people to specify any of the | |
equivalent URLs and have Git automatically rewrite the URL to | |
the best alternative for the particular user, even for a | |
never-before-seen repository on the site. When more than one | |
insteadOf strings match a given URL, the longest match is used. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that any protocol restrictions will be applied to the rewritten | |
URL. If the rewrite changes the URL to use a custom protocol or remote | |
helper, you may need to adjust the <code>protocol.*.allow</code> config to permit | |
the request. In particular, protocols you expect to use for submodules | |
must be set to <code>always</code> rather than the default of <code>user</code>. See the | |
description of <code>protocol.allow</code> above.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
url.<base>.pushInsteadOf | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Any URL that starts with this value will not be pushed to; | |
instead, it will be rewritten to start with <base>, and the | |
resulting URL will be pushed to. In cases where some site serves | |
a large number of repositories, and serves them with multiple | |
access methods, some of which do not allow push, this feature | |
allows people to specify a pull-only URL and have Git | |
automatically use an appropriate URL to push, even for a | |
never-before-seen repository on the site. When more than one | |
pushInsteadOf strings match a given URL, the longest match is | |
used. If a remote has an explicit pushurl, Git will ignore this | |
setting for that remote. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
user.name | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
user.email | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
author.name | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
author.email | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
committer.name | |
</dt> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
committer.email | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
The <code>user.name</code> and <code>user.email</code> variables determine what ends | |
up in the <code>author</code> and <code>committer</code> field of commit | |
objects. | |
If you need the <code>author</code> or <code>committer</code> to be different, the | |
<code>author.name</code>, <code>author.email</code>, <code>committer.name</code> or | |
<code>committer.email</code> variables can be set. | |
Also, all of these can be overridden by the <code>GIT_AUTHOR_NAME</code>, | |
<code>GIT_AUTHOR_EMAIL</code>, <code>GIT_COMMITTER_NAME</code>, | |
<code>GIT_COMMITTER_EMAIL</code> and <code>EMAIL</code> environment variables. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that the <code>name</code> forms of these variables conventionally refer to | |
some form of a personal name. See <a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a> and the | |
environment variables section of <a href="git.html">git(1)</a> for more information on | |
these settings and the <code>credential.username</code> option if you’re looking | |
for authentication credentials instead.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
user.useConfigOnly | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Instruct Git to avoid trying to guess defaults for <code>user.email</code> | |
and <code>user.name</code>, and instead retrieve the values only from the | |
configuration. For example, if you have multiple email addresses | |
and would like to use a different one for each repository, then | |
with this configuration option set to <code>true</code> in the global config | |
along with a name, Git will prompt you to set up an email before | |
making new commits in a newly cloned repository. | |
Defaults to <code>false</code>. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
user.signingKey | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If <a href="git-tag.html">git-tag(1)</a> or <a href="git-commit.html">git-commit(1)</a> is not selecting the | |
key you want it to automatically when creating a signed tag or | |
commit, you can override the default selection with this variable. | |
This option is passed unchanged to gpg’s --local-user parameter, | |
so you may specify a key using any method that gpg supports. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
versionsort.prereleaseSuffix (deprecated) | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Deprecated alias for <code>versionsort.suffix</code>. Ignored if | |
<code>versionsort.suffix</code> is set. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
versionsort.suffix | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Even when version sort is used in <a href="git-tag.html">git-tag(1)</a>, tagnames | |
with the same base version but different suffixes are still sorted | |
lexicographically, resulting e.g. in prerelease tags appearing | |
after the main release (e.g. "1.0-rc1" after "1.0"). This | |
variable can be specified to determine the sorting order of tags | |
with different suffixes. | |
</p> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>By specifying a single suffix in this variable, any tagname containing | |
that suffix will appear before the corresponding main release. E.g. if | |
the variable is set to "-rc", then all "1.0-rcX" tags will appear before | |
"1.0". If specified multiple times, once per suffix, then the order of | |
suffixes in the configuration will determine the sorting order of tagnames | |
with those suffixes. E.g. if "-pre" appears before "-rc" in the | |
configuration, then all "1.0-preX" tags will be listed before any | |
"1.0-rcX" tags. The placement of the main release tag relative to tags | |
with various suffixes can be determined by specifying the empty suffix | |
among those other suffixes. E.g. if the suffixes "-rc", "", "-ck" and | |
"-bfs" appear in the configuration in this order, then all "v4.8-rcX" tags | |
are listed first, followed by "v4.8", then "v4.8-ckX" and finally | |
"v4.8-bfsX".</p></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>If more than one suffixes match the same tagname, then that tagname will | |
be sorted according to the suffix which starts at the earliest position in | |
the tagname. If more than one different matching suffixes start at | |
that earliest position, then that tagname will be sorted according to the | |
longest of those suffixes. | |
The sorting order between different suffixes is undefined if they are | |
in multiple config files.</p></div> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
web.browser | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
Specify a web browser that may be used by some commands. | |
Currently only <a href="git-instaweb.html">git-instaweb(1)</a> and <a href="git-help.html">git-help(1)</a> | |
may use it. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
<dt class="hdlist1"> | |
worktree.guessRemote | |
</dt> | |
<dd> | |
<p> | |
If no branch is specified and neither <code>-b</code> nor <code>-B</code> nor | |
<code>--detach</code> is used, then <code>git worktree add</code> defaults to | |
creating a new branch from HEAD. If <code>worktree.guessRemote</code> is | |
set to true, <code>worktree add</code> tries to find a remote-tracking | |
branch whose name uniquely matches the new branch name. If | |
such a branch exists, it is checked out and set as "upstream" | |
for the new branch. If no such match can be found, it falls | |
back to creating a new branch from the current HEAD. | |
</p> | |
</dd> | |
</dl></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="_bugs">BUGS</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>When using the deprecated <code>[section.subsection]</code> syntax, changing a value | |
will result in adding a multi-line key instead of a change, if the subsection | |
is given with at least one uppercase character. For example when the config | |
looks like</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code> [section.subsection] | |
key = value1</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>and running <code>git config section.Subsection.key value2</code> will result in</p></div> | |
<div class="listingblock"> | |
<div class="content"> | |
<pre><code> [section.subsection] | |
key = value1 | |
key = value2</code></pre> | |
</div></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div class="sect1"> | |
<h2 id="_git">GIT</h2> | |
<div class="sectionbody"> | |
<div class="paragraph"><p>Part of the <a href="git.html">git(1)</a> suite</p></div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
<div id="footnotes"><hr /></div> | |
<div id="footer"> | |
<div id="footer-text"> | |
Last updated | |
2021-09-23 14:33:59 PDT | |
</div> | |
</div> | |
</body> | |
</html> |